Lexmark 50M7080 CX635adwe Wired & Wireless Laser Multifunction Printer Color

Product's Documents

Below are documents related to this product, you can read online or download:
User Manual Specification
50M7080 photo

Product Manual

This is the main product document for model 50M7080.

The file format is pdf, 336 pages, you can download this manual here .

background
CX532, CX635, XC2335 MFPs
User's Guide
April 2023 www.lexmark.com
Machine type:
7531
Models:
276, 286, 289, 676, 686
background
Contents
Safety information........................................................................................ 6
Conventions.......................................................................................................................................................... 6
Product statements............................................................................................................................................. 6
Learn about the printer................................................................................ 9
Finding information about the printer.............................................................................................................9
Finding the printer serial number...................................................................................................................10
Printer configurations........................................................................................................................................10
Using the control panel.................................................................................................................................... 12
Understanding the status of the indicator light..........................................................................................12
Selecting paper...................................................................................................................................................12
Set up, install, and configure.................................................................... 22
Selecting a location for the printer............................................................................................................... 22
Attaching cables................................................................................................................................................ 23
Setting up and using the home screen applications...............................................................................24
Setting up and using the accessibility features.........................................................................................30
Setting up the printer to fax............................................................................................................................33
Configuring the email SMTP settings......................................................................................................... 39
Loading paper and specialty media............................................................................................................. 47
Installing and updating software, drivers, and firmware.........................................................................54
Installing hardware options............................................................................................................................ 56
Networking..........................................................................................................................................................68
Secure the printer.......................................................................................72
Locating the security slot.................................................................................................................................72
Erasing printer memory....................................................................................................................................72
Erasing printer storage drive.......................................................................................................................... 73
Restoring factory default settings..................................................................................................................73
Statement of Volatility.......................................................................................................................................73
Print.............................................................................................................. 75
Printing from a computer.................................................................................................................................75
Printing from a mobile device........................................................................................................................ 75
Printing from a flash drive................................................................................................................................77
Contents 2
background
Supported flash drives and file types...........................................................................................................78
Configuring confidential jobs......................................................................................................................... 78
Printing confidential and other held jobs.................................................................................................... 79
Printing a font sample list................................................................................................................................80
Printing a directory list..................................................................................................................................... 80
Placing separator sheets between copies.................................................................................................80
Canceling a print job........................................................................................................................................ 80
Adjusting toner darkness................................................................................................................................80
Copy.............................................................................................................. 81
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass..................................................................... 81
Making copies..................................................................................................................................................... 81
Copying photos...................................................................................................................................................81
Copying on letterhead.....................................................................................................................................82
Copying on both sides of the paper............................................................................................................ 82
Reducing or enlarging copies........................................................................................................................82
Collating copies................................................................................................................................................. 82
Placing separator sheets between copies................................................................................................. 82
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet............................................................................................. 83
Copying cards.................................................................................................................................................... 83
Creating a copy shortcut................................................................................................................................. 83
E-mail............................................................................................................84
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass.................................................................... 84
Sending an e-mail..............................................................................................................................................84
Creating an e-mail shortcut............................................................................................................................ 84
Fax................................................................................................................ 85
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass.................................................................... 85
Sending a fax......................................................................................................................................................85
Scheduling a fax................................................................................................................................................ 86
Creating a fax destination shortcut.............................................................................................................. 86
Changing the fax resolution........................................................................................................................... 86
Adjusting the fax darkness..............................................................................................................................87
Printing a fax log................................................................................................................................................ 87
Blocking junk faxes........................................................................................................................................... 87
Holding faxes......................................................................................................................................................87
Contents 3
background
Forwarding a fax................................................................................................................................................ 87
Scan..............................................................................................................89
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass.................................................................... 89
Scanning to a computer.................................................................................................................................. 89
Scanning to an FTP server..............................................................................................................................90
Creating an FTP shortcut................................................................................................................................. 91
Scanning to a network folder..........................................................................................................................91
Creating a network folder shortcut................................................................................................................91
Scanning to a flash drive.................................................................................................................................92
Use printer menus...................................................................................... 93
Menu map............................................................................................................................................................93
Device...................................................................................................................................................................94
Print..................................................................................................................................................................... 109
Paper.................................................................................................................................................................... 118
Copy....................................................................................................................................................................120
Fax....................................................................................................................................................................... 124
E-mail...................................................................................................................................................................139
FTP.......................................................................................................................................................................145
USB Drive...........................................................................................................................................................149
Network/Ports................................................................................................................................................... 154
Security...............................................................................................................................................................168
Cloud Services..................................................................................................................................................175
Reports................................................................................................................................................................176
Troubleshooting................................................................................................................................................177
Forms Merge..................................................................................................................................................... 177
Printing the Menu Settings Page................................................................................................................. 179
Maintain the printer..................................................................................180
Checking the status of parts and supplies................................................................................................180
Configuring supply notifications.................................................................................................................. 180
Setting up email alerts.................................................................................................................................. 180
Viewing reports................................................................................................................................................. 181
Ordering parts and supplies.......................................................................................................................... 181
Replacing parts and supplies........................................................................................................................184
Cleaning printer parts....................................................................................................................................229
Contents 4
background
Saving energy and paper..............................................................................................................................237
Moving the printer to another location......................................................................................................237
Shipping the printer........................................................................................................................................238
Troubleshoot a problem.......................................................................... 239
Print quality problems....................................................................................................................................239
Printer error codes......................................................................................................................................... 240
Printing problems............................................................................................................................................247
The printer is not responding...................................................................................................................... 273
Unable to read flash drive............................................................................................................................ 274
Enabling the USB port................................................................................................................................... 275
Clearing jams................................................................................................................................................... 275
Network connection problems....................................................................................................................284
Hardware options problems........................................................................................................................ 287
Issues with supplies....................................................................................................................................... 288
Paper feed problems..................................................................................................................................... 289
E-mailing problems.........................................................................................................................................292
Faxing problems..............................................................................................................................................293
Scanning problems........................................................................................................................................ 299
Color quality problems.................................................................................................................................. 306
Contacting customer support......................................................................................................................308
Recycle and dispose................................................................................ 309
Recycling Lexmark products........................................................................................................................309
Recycling Lexmark packaging.....................................................................................................................309
Notices........................................................................................................310
Index...........................................................................................................330
Contents 5
background
Safety information
Conventions
Note: A note identifies information that could help you.
Warning: A warning identifies something that could damage the product hardware or software.
CAUTION: A caution indicates a potentially hazardous situation that could injure you.
Dierent types of caution statements include:
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Indicates a risk of injury.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Indicates a risk of electrical shock.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: Indicates a risk of burn if touched.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Indicates a crush hazard.
CAUTION—PINCH HAZARD: Indicates a risk of being caught between moving parts.
Product statements
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord to
an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not use this product with extension cords, multioutlet power strips,
multioutlet extenders, or UPS devices. The power capacity of these types of accessories can be easily
overloaded by a laser printer and may result in a risk of fire, property damage, or poor printer
performance.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Only a Lexmark Inline Surge Protector that is properly connected
between the printer and the power cord provided with the printer may be used with this product. The
use of non-Lexmark surge protection devices may result in a risk of fire, property damage, or poor
printer performance.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not place or use this product near
water or wet locations.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
Safety information 6
background
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not cut, twist, bind, crush, or place heavy objects on the power
cord. Do not subject the power cord to abrasion or stress. Do not pinch the power cord between objects
such as furniture and walls. If any of these things happen, a risk of fire or electrical shock results. Inspect
the power cord regularly for signs of such problems. Remove the power cord from the electrical outlet
before inspecting it.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, make sure that all external
connections (such as Ethernet and telephone system connections) are properly installed in their marked
plug-in ports.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not use the fax feature during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: If the printer weight is greater than 20 kg (44 lb), then it may require
two or more people to lift it safely.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: When moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal
injury or printer damage:
Make sure that all doors and trays are closed.
Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer.
If the printer has separate floor-standing optional trays or output options attached to it, then disconnect
them before moving the printer.
If the printer has a caster base, then carefully roll it to the new location. Use caution when passing over
thresholds and breaks in
flooring.
If the printer does not have a caster base but is configured with optional trays or output options, then remove
the output options and lift the printer
o
the trays. Do not try to lift the printer and any options at the same
time.
Always use the handholds on the printer to lift it.
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the
options.
Keep the printer in an upright position.
Avoid severe jarring movements.
Make sure that your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.
Make sure that there is adequate clearance around the printer.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Installing one or more options on your printer or MFP may require a
caster base, furniture, or other feature to prevent instability causing possible injury. For more information
on supported configurations, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
Safety information 7
background
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
CAUTION—PINCH HAZARD: To avoid the risk of a pinch injury, use caution in areas marked with this
label. Pinch injuries may occur around moving parts, such as gears, doors, trays, and covers.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: This product uses a laser. Use of controls or adjustments or
performance of procedures other than those specified in the User’s Guide may result in hazardous
radiation exposure.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The lithium battery in this product is not intended to be replaced.
There is a danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced. Do not recharge, disassemble,
or incinerate a lithium battery. Discard used lithium batteries according to the manufacturer's instructions
and local regulations.
This product is designed, tested, and approved to meet strict global safety standards with the use of specific
manufacturer's components. The safety features of some parts may not always be obvious. The manufacturer
is not responsible for the use of other replacement parts.
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the user documentation, to a service representative.
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS.
Safety information 8
background
Learn about the printer
Finding information about the printer
What are you looking for? Find it here
Initial setup instructions See the setup documentation that came with the
printer.
Printer software
Print or fax driver
Printer firmware
Utility
Go to
www.lexmark.com/downloads, search for
your printer model, and then in the Type menu,
select the driver,
firmware,
or utility that you need.
Selecting and storing paper and specialty media
Loading paper
Configuring printer settings
Viewing and printing documents and photos
Configuring the printer on a network
Caring for and maintaining the printer
Troubleshooting and solving problems
Information Center—Go to
https://infoserve.lexmark.com.
Howto videos—Go to
https://infoserve.lexmark.com/idv/.
Help information for using the printer software. Help for Microsoft Windows or Macintosh operating
systems—Open a printer software program or
application, and then click Help.
Click
?
to view contextsensitive information.
Notes:
Help is automatically installed with the printer
software.
Depending on the operating system, the
printer software is either in the printer
program folder or on the desktop.
Documentation
Live chat support
Email support
Voice support
Go to
https://support.lexmark.com.
Note: Select your country or region, and then
select your product to view the appropriate
support site.
Support contact information for your country or
region can be found on the website or on the
printed warranty that came with the printer.
Have the following information ready when you
contact customer support:
Place and date of purchase
Machine type and serial number
For more information, see
“Finding the printer
serial number” on page 10.
Learn about the printer 9
background
What are you looking for? Find it here
Safety information
Regulatory information
Warranty information
Environmental information
Warranty information varies by country or region:
In the U.S.—See the Statement of Limited
Warranty included with the printer, or go to
https://support.lexmark.com.
In other countries and regions—See the
printed warranty that came with the printer.
Product Information Guide—See the
documentation that came with the printer or go to
https://support.lexmark.com.
Information on Lexmark digital passport Go to
https://csr.lexmark.com/digital-
passport.php.
Finding the printer serial number
1 Open door A.
2 Locate the serial number.
Printer configurations
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Installing one or more options on your printer or MFP may require a
caster base, furniture, or other feature to prevent instability causing possible injury. For more information
on supported configurations, see
www.lexmark.com/multifunctionprinters.
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
You can configure your printer by adding any of the following options:
A 650-sheet duo tray
A 650-sheet duo tray and up to two 550-sheet trays
Learn about the printer 10
background
Up to three 550-sheet trays
For more information, see
“Installing optional trays” on page 57.
1 ADF tray
2 ADF bin
3 Control panel
4 Standard 250-sheet tray
5 Optional 650-sheet duo tray
Note: The tray is composed of a 550sheet tray and a 100sheet multipurpose feeder.
6 Optional 550-sheet trays
7 Manual feeder
8 Standard bin
9 Convenience stapler
10 Automatic document feeder (ADF)
Learn about the printer 11
background
Using the control panel
Control panel part Function
1 Power button
Turn on or turn o the printer.
Note: To turn o the printer, press and hold the power button for five seconds.
Set the printer to Sleep mode.
Wake the printer from Sleep or Hibernate mode.
2 Display
View the printer messages and supply status.
Set up and operate the printer.
3 Indicator light Check the status of the printer.
Understanding the status of the indicator light
Indicator light Printer status
O The printer is o.
Solid blue The printer is ready.
Blinking blue The printer is printing or processing data.
Blinking red The printer requires user intervention.
Solid amber The printer is in Sleep mode.
Blinking amber The printer is in Deep Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Selecting paper
Paper guidelines
Use the appropriate paper to prevent jams and help ensure troublefree printing.
Always use new, undamaged paper.
Before loading paper, know the recommended printable side of the paper. This information is usually
indicated on the paper package.
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.
Learn about the printer 12
background
Do not mix paper sizes, types, or weights in the same tray; mixing results in jams.
Do not use coated papers unless they are specifically designed for electrophotographic printing.
For more information, see the Paper and Specialty Media Guide.
Paper characteristics
The following paper characteristics aect print quality and reliability. Consider these factors before printing on
them.
Weight
Trays can feed paper of varying weights. Paper lighter than 60 g/m
2
(16 lb) may not be sti enough to feed
properly, and may cause jams. For more information, see the “Supported paper weights” topic.
Curl
Curl is the tendency for paper to curl at its edges. Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems. Curl can
occur after the paper passes through the printer, where it is exposed to high temperatures. Storing paper
unwrapped in hot, humid, cold, or dry conditions can contribute to paper curling before printing and can cause
feeding problems.
Smoothness
Paper smoothness directly aects print quality. If paper is too rough, toner cannot fuse to it properly. If paper
is too smooth, it can cause paper feeding or print quality issues. We recommend the use of paper with 50
Sheeld points.
Moisture content
The amount of moisture in paper aects both print quality and the printer ability to feed the paper correctly.
Leave paper in its original wrapper until you use it. Exposure of paper to moisture changes can degrade its
performance.
Before printing, store paper in its original wrapper for 24 to 48 hours. The environment in which the paper is
stored must be the same as the printer . Extend the time several days if the storage or transportation
environment is very dierent from the printer environment. Thick paper may also require a longer conditioning
period.
Grain direction
Grain refers to the alignment of the paper
fibers
in a sheet of paper. Grain is either grain long which runs the
length of the paper, or grain short which runs the width of the paper. For recommended grain direction, see the
“Supported paper weights” topic.
Fiber content
Most highquality xerographic paper is made from 100 percent chemically treated pulped wood. This content
provides the paper with a high degree of stability, resulting in fewer paper feeding problems and better print
quality. Paper containing fibers such as cotton can negatively aect paper handling.
Learn about the printer 13
background
Unacceptable paper
The following paper types are not recommended for use with the printer:
Chemically treated papers that are used to make copies without carbon paper. They are also known as
carbonless papers, carbonless copy paper (CCP), or no carbon required (NCR) paper.
Preprinted papers with chemicals that may contaminate the printer.
Preprinted papers that can be aected by the temperature in the printer fuser.
Preprinted papers that require a registration (the precise print location on the page) greater than ±2.3 mm
(±0.09 in.). For example, optical character recognition (OCR) forms.
Sometimes, registration can be adjusted with a software app to print successfully on these forms.
Coated papers (erasable bond), synthetic papers, or thermal papers.
Roughedged, rough or heavily textured surface papers, or curled papers.
Recycled papers that fail EN12281:2002 (European).
Paper weighing less than 60 g/m
2
(16 lb).
Multiplepart forms or documents.
Storing paper
Use these paper storage guidelines to help avoid jams and uneven print quality:
Store paper in its original wrapper in the same environment as the printer for 24 to 48 hours before printing.
Extend the time several days if the storage or transportation environment is very dierent from the printer
environment. Thick paper may also require a longer conditioning period.
For best results, store paper where the temperature is 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40 percent.
Most label manufacturers recommend printing in a temperature range of 18–24°C (65–75°F) with relative
humidity between 40 and 60 percent.
Store paper in cartons, on a pallet or shelf, rather than on the floor.
Store individual packages on a flat surface.
Do not store anything on top of individual paper packages.
Take paper out of the carton or wrapper only when you are ready to load it in the printer. The carton and
wrapper help keep the paper clean, dry, and flat.
Selecting preprinted forms and letterhead
Use grain long paper.
Use only forms and letterhead printed using an oset lithographic or engraved printing process.
Avoid paper with rough or heavily textured surfaces.
Use inks that are not aected by the resin in toner. Inks that are oxidationset or oilbased generally meet
these requirements; latex inks might not.
Print samples on preprinted forms and letterheads considered for use before buying large quantities. This
action determines whether the ink in the preprinted form or letterhead aects print quality.
When in doubt, contact your paper supplier.
When printing on letterhead, load the paper in the proper orientation for your printer. For more information,
see the Paper and Specialty Media Guide.
Learn about the printer 14
background
Supported paper sizes
Paper sizes supported by the trays, manual feeder, and two-sided printing
Paper size and
dimension
Standard
250
sheet tray
Manual
feeder
Optional 650
sheet duo tray Optional
550
sheet
tray
Two
sided
printing
550
sheet
tray
Multipurpose
feeder
A4
210 x 297 mm (8.27 x 11.7
in.)
A5 Portrait (SEF)
1,2
148 x 210 mm (5.83 x 8.27
in.)
XX
X X
A5 Landscape (LEF)
1,2
210 x 148 mm (8.27 x 5.83
in.)
XXXX
A6
105 x 148 mm (4.13 x 5.83
in.)
X XX
1/3 A4
95 x 210 mm (3.7 x 8.3 in.)
X XX
JIS B5
182 x 257 mm (7.17 x 10.1
in.)
X
Letter
215.9 x 279.4 mm (8.5 x 11
in.)
Legal
215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x
14 in.)
Executive
184.2 x 266.7 mm (7.25 x
10.5 in.)
X
1
Load this paper size into the standard tray and the manual feeder with the long edge entering the printer first.
2
Load this paper size into the optional trays and the multipurpose feeder with the short edge entering the printer
first.
3
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified
by the software application.
4
Load narrow paper with the short edge entering the printer first.
5
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is
specified by the software application.
Learn about the printer 15
background
Paper size and
dimension
Standard
250
sheet tray
Manual
feeder
Optional 650
sheet duo tray Optional
550
sheet
tray
Two
sided
printing
550
sheet
tray
Multipurpose
feeder
Oficio (Mexico)
215.9 x 340.4 mm (8.5 x
13.4 in.)
Folio
215.9 x 330.2 mm (8.5 x
13 in.)
Statement
139.7 x 215.9 mm (5.5 x
8.5 in.)
X XX
Hagaki
100 x 148 mm (3.94 x 5.83
in.)
X XX
Universal
3,4
98.4 x 148 mm to 215.9 x
355.6 mm (3.87 x 5.83 in.
to 8.5 x 14 in.)
X XX
Universal
3,4
76.2 x 127 mm to 215.9 x
355.6 mm (3 x 5 in. to 8.5
x 14 in.)
X
X XX
Universal
3,4
148 x 210 mm to 215.9 x
355.6 mm (5.83 x 8.27 in.
to 8.5 x 14 in.)
X
Universal
3,4
210 x 250 mm to 215.9 x
355.6 mm (8.27 x 9.84 in.
to 8.5 x 14 in.)
7 3/4 Envelope
98.4 x 190.5 mm (3.875 x
7.5 in.)
X XX
1
Load this paper size into the standard tray and the manual feeder with the long edge entering the printer first.
2
Load this paper size into the optional trays and the multipurpose feeder with the short edge entering the printer
first.
3
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is
specified
by the software application.
4
Load narrow paper with the short edge entering the printer first.
5
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is
specified
by the software application.
Learn about the printer 16
background
Paper size and
dimension
Standard
250
sheet tray
Manual
feeder
Optional 650
sheet duo tray Optional
550
sheet
tray
Two
sided
printing
550
sheet
tray
Multipurpose
feeder
9 Envelope
98.4 x 225.4 mm (3.875 x
8.9 in.)
X XX
10 Envelope
104.8 x 241.3 mm (4.12 x
9.5 in.)
X XX
DL Envelope
110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66
in.)
X XX
C5 Envelope
162 x 229 mm (6.38 x 9.01
in.)
X XX
B5 Envelope
176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84
in.)
X XX
Monarch
98.425 x 190.5 mm (3.875
x 7.5 in.)
XXXXXX
Other Envelope
5
98.4 x 162 mm to 176 x
250 mm (3.87 x 6.38 in. to
6.93 x 9.84 in.)
X XX
1
Load this paper size into the standard tray and the manual feeder with the long edge entering the printer first.
2
Load this paper size into the optional trays and the multipurpose feeder with the short edge entering the printer
first.
3
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified
by the software application.
4
Load narrow paper with the short edge entering the printer first.
5
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is
specified by the software application.
Learn about the printer 17
background
Paper sizes supported by the scanner and automatic document feeder
Paper size and dimension Scanner Automatic document
feeder
A4
210 x 297 mm (8.27 x 11.7 in.)
A5 Portrait (SEF)
148 x 210 mm (5.83 x 8.27 in.)
A5 Landscape (LEF)
210 x 148 mm (8.27 x 5.83 in.)
A6
105 x 148 mm (4.13 x 5.83 in.)
1/3 A4
95 x 210 mm (3.7 x 8.3 in.)
X
JIS B5
182 x 257 mm (7.17 x 10.1 in.)
Letter
215.9 x 279.4 mm (8.5 x 11 in.)
Legal
215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.)
Executive
184.2 x 266.7 mm (7.25 x 10.5 in.)
Oficio (Mexico)
215.9 x 340.4 mm (8.5 x 13.4 in.)
Folio
215.9 x 330.2 mm (8.5 x 13 in.)
Statement
139.7 x 215.9 mm (5.5 x 8.5 in.)
Hagaki
100 x 148 mm (3.94 x 5.83 in.)
X
Universal
1,2
98.4 x 148 mm to 215.9 x 355.6 mm (3.87 x 5.83 in. to 8.5
x 14 in.)
X
Universal
1,2
76.2 x 127 mm to 215.9 x 355.6 mm (3 x 5 in. to 8.5 x 14 in.)
X
1
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified
by the software application.
2
Load narrow paper with the short edge entering the printer
first.
3
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is
specified by the software application.
Learn about the printer 18
background
Paper size and dimension Scanner Automatic document
feeder
Universal
1,2
148 x 210 mm to 215.9 x 355.6 mm (5.83 x 8.27 in. to 8.5 x
14 in.)
Universal
1,2
210 x 250 mm to 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.27 x 9.84 in. to 8.5 x
14 in.)
7 3/4 Envelope
98.4 x 190.5 mm (3.875 x 7.5 in.)
X
9 Envelope
98.4 x 225.4 mm (3.875 x 8.9 in.)
X
10 Envelope
104.8 x 241.3 mm (4.12 x 9.5 in.)
X
DL Envelope
110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66 in.)
X
C5 Envelope
162 x 229 mm (6.38 x 9.01 in.)
X
B5 Envelope
176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84 in.)
X
Monarch
98.425 x 190.5 mm (3.875 x 7.5 in.)
X
Other Envelope
3
98.4 x 162 mm to 176 x 250 mm (3.87 x 6.38 in. to 6.93 x
9.84 in.)
X
1
When Universal is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified
by the software application.
2
Load narrow paper with the short edge entering the printer first.
3
When Other Envelope is selected, the page is formatted for 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is
specified by the software application.
Note: Your printer model may have a 650sheet duo tray, which consists of a 550sheet tray and an
integrated 100sheet multipurpose feeder. The 550sheet tray of the 650sheet duo tray supports the same
paper sizes as the optional 550sheet tray. The integrated multipurpose feeder supports dierent paper
sizes, types, and weights.
Learn about the printer 19
background
Supported paper types
Paper types supported by the trays, manual feeder, and two-sided printing
Paper type
Standard
250-sheet
tray
Manual
feeder
Optional 650
sheet duo tray
Optional
550
sheet
tray
Two
sided
printing
550
sheet
tray
Multipurpose
feeder
Plain
Card stock X
Labels
Vinyl Labels X
Envelope
X XX
Paper types supported by the scanner and ADF
Paper type Scanner ADF
Plain
Card stock X
Labels
X
Vinyl Labels
X
Envelope
X
Notes:
Your printer model may have a 650-sheet duo tray, which consists of a 550-sheet tray and an integrated
100-sheet multipurpose feeder. The 550-sheet tray of the 650-sheet duo tray supports the same paper
type as the 550-sheet tray. The integrated multipurpose feeder supports dierent paper sizes, types,
and weights.
Labels, envelopes, and card stock always print at reduced speed.
Vinyl labels are supported for occasional use only and must be tested for acceptability. Some vinyl labels
may feed more reliably from the multipurpose feeder.
Learn about the printer 20
background
Supported paper weights
Standard 250-
sheet tray
Manual
feeder
Optional 650
sheet duo tray
Optional
550
sheet tray
Two
sided
printing
ADF
550
sheet tray
Multipurpose
feeder
60–200 g/m
2
(16–53lb
bond)
60–
200 g/m
2
(16–53lb
bond)
60–162 g/m
2
(16–43lb bond)
60–162 g/m
2
(16–43lb bond)
60–162 g/m
2
(16–43lb bond)
60–105 g/m
2
(16–28lb
bond)
52–
120 g/m
2
(14–32lb
bond)
Notes:
Your printer model may have a 650-sheet duo tray, which consists of a 550-sheet tray and an integrated
100-sheet multipurpose feeder. The 550-sheet tray of the 650-sheet duo tray supports the same paper
types as the 550-sheet tray. The integrated multipurpose feeder supports dierent paper sizes, types,
and weights.
For 60 to 162 g/m
2
(16–43lb bond) paper, grain long fibers are recommended.
Paper less than 75 g/m
2
(20lb bond) must be printed with Paper Type set to Light Paper. Failure to do so
may cause excessive curl which can lead to feeding errors, especially in more humid environments.
Learn about the printer 21
background
Set up, install, and
configure
Selecting a location for the printer
Leave enough room to open trays, covers, and doors and to install hardware options.
Set up the printer near an electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not place or use this product
near water or wet locations.
Make sure that airflow in the room meets the latest revision of the ASHRAE 62 standard or the CEN Technical
Committee 156 standard.
Provide a
flat,
sturdy, and stable surface.
Keep the printer:
Clean, dry, and free of dust.
Away from stray staples and paper clips.
Away from the direct airflow of air conditioners, heaters, or ventilators.
Free from direct sunlight and humidity extremes.
Observe the recommended temperatures and avoid fluctuations:
Ambient temperature 10 to 32.2°C (50 to 90°F)
Storage temperature 15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)
Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer for proper ventilation:
1 Top 305 mm (12 in . )
2 Rear 102 mm (4 in.)
Set up, install, and configure 22
background
3 Right side 76 mm (3 in.)
4 Front 508 mm (20 in.)
Note: The minimum space needed in front of the machine is 76 mm (3 in.).
5 Left side 76 mm (3 in.)
Attaching cables
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord to
an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch the USB cable, any
wireless network adapter, or the printer in the areas shown while actively printing.
Printer port Function
1 LINE port Connect the printer to an active telephone line through a standard wall jack (RJ11), DSL
filter, or VoIP adapter, or any other adapter that allows you to access the telephone line
to send and receive faxes.
2 Power cord socket Connect the printer to a properly grounded electrical outlet.
3 USB printer port Connect the printer to a computer.
4 USB port Attach a keyboard or any compatible option.
Set up, install, and configure 23
background
Printer port Function
5 Ethernet port Connect the printer to a network.
Setting up and using the home screen applications
Using the home screen
Note: Your home screen may vary depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative
setup, and active embedded solutions.
#Icon Function
1 Stop or Cancel button Stop the current job.
2 Copy Make copies.
3 Change Language Change the language on the printer display.
4 Email Send emails.
5 Settings Access the printer menus.
6 Fax Send fax.
7 Address Book Access, create, and organize contacts.
8 Status/Supplies
Show a printer warning or error message whenever the printer requires
intervention to continue processing.
View more information on the printer warning or message, and on how to clear
it.
Note: You can also access this setting by touching the top section of the home
screen.
9 Held Jobs Show all the current held print jobs
10 Job Queue Show all the current print jobs.
Note: You can also access this setting by touching the top section of the home
screen.
11 USB Drive View, select, or print photos and documents from a flash drive.
Set up, install, and configure 24
background
#Icon Function
12 Scan Profiles Scan and save documents directly to the computer.
13 FTP Scan and save documents directly to an FTP server.
14 Bookmarks Organize all bookmarks.
15 Hard Disk View, select, and manage documents from a hard drive or an intelligent storage drive.
16 Network Folder Scan to a network folder or network location.
17 Start button Start a job, depending on which mode is selected.
18 Onscreen keypad Enter numbers or symbols in an input field.
Customizing the home screen
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Device > Home Screen Customization.
3 Do one or more of the following:
To add an icon to the home screen, click
, select the app name, and then click Add.
To remove a home screen icon, select the app name, and then click Remove.
To customize an app name, select the app name, click Edit, and then assign a name.
To restore the name of an app, select the app name, click Edit, and then select Restore app label.
To add a space between apps, click
, select BLANK SPACE, and then click Add.
To arrange the apps, drag the app names in the order that you want.
To restore the default home screen, click Restore home screen.
4 Apply the changes.
Supported applications
Application Printer models
Scan Center CX532, CX635, XC2335
Shortcut Center CX532, CX635, XC2335
Card Copy CX532, CX635, XC2335
Display Customization CX532, CX635, XC2335
Customer Support XC2335
Device Quotas XC2335
Set up, install, and configure 25
background
Setting up Scan Center
1 From the home screen, touch Scan Center.
2 Select and create a destination, and then configure the settings.
Notes:
When creating a network destination, make sure to validate and adjust the settings until no errors
occur.
Only destinations created from the Embedded Web Server are saved. For more information, see the
documentation that came with the solution.
3 Apply the changes.
Creating a shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch Shortcut Center.
Note: The icon and name may have been changed. For more information, contact your administrator.
2 Select a printer function, and then touch Create Shortcut.
Note: The Secure Email function is not supported.
3 Configure the settings, and then touch Save.
4 Type a unique shortcut name.
Note: To avoid clipped names on the home screen, type only up to 25 characters.
5 Tou ch OK.
The application automatically generates a unique shortcut number.
Note: To launch the shortcut, touch
, touch #, and then enter the shortcut number.
Setting up Card Copy
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Apps > Card Copy >
Configure
.
Notes:
Make sure that Display Icon is enabled.
Make sure that Email Settings and Network Share Settings are configured.
When scanning a card, make sure that the scan resolution does not exceed 200 dpi for color and
400 dpi for black and white.
When scanning multiple cards, make sure that the scan resolution does not exceed 150 dpi for color
and 300 dpi for black and white.
Set up, install, and configure 26
background
3 Apply the changes.
Note: You need a printer hard disk or an intelligent storage drive to scan multiple cards.
Using Display Customization
Before using the application, make sure to enable and configure the screen saver, slideshow, and wallpaper
settings from the Embedded Web Server.
Managing screen saver and slide show images
1 From the Embedded Web Server, click Apps > Display Customization >
Configure
.
2 In the Screen Saver and Slideshow Images section, add, edit, or delete an image.
Notes:
You can add up to 10 images.
When enabled, the status icons appear on the screen saver only when there are errors, warnings, or
cloudbased notifications.
3 Apply the changes.
Changing the wallpaper image
1 From the home screen, touch Change Wallpaper.
2 Select an image to use.
3 Apply the changes.
Running a slide show from a flash drive
1 Insert a flash drive into the front USB port.
2 From the home screen, touch Slideshow.
Note: You can remove the flash drive after the slide show starts, but the images are not stored in the printer.
If the slide show stops, then insert the flash drive again to view the images.
Using Customer Support
Notes:
This application is supported only in some printer models. For more information, see
“Supported
applications” on page 25.
For information on how to configure the application settings, see the Customer Support Administrator’s
Guide.
1 From the home screen, touch Customer Support.
2 Print or email the information.
Set up, install, and configure 27
background
Setting up Device Quotas
Notes:
This application is supported only in some printer models. For more information, see “Supported
applications” on page 25.
For information on how to configure the application settings, see the Device Quotas Administrator’s
Guide.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Apps > Device Quotas > Configure.
3 In the User Accounts section, add or edit a user, and then set the user quota.
4 Apply the changes.
Managing bookmarks
Creating bookmarks
Use bookmarks to print frequently accessed documents that are stored in servers or on the web.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Bookmarks > Add Bookmark, and then type a bookmark name.
3 Select an Address protocol type, and then do one of the following:
For HTTP and HTTPS, type the URL that you want to bookmark.
For HTTPS, make sure to use the host name instead of the IP address. For example, type
myWebsite.com/sample.pdf instead of typing 123.123.123.123/sample.pdf. Make sure that
the host name also matches the Common Name (CN) value in the server certificate. For more information
on obtaining the CN value in the server certificate, see the help information for your web browser.
For FTP, type the FTP address. For example, myServer/myDirectory. Enter the FTP port number.
Port 21 is the default port for sending commands.
For SMB, type the network folder address. For example, myServer/myShare/myFile.pdf. Type the
network domain name.
If necessary, select the Authentication type for FTP and SMB.
To limit access to the bookmark, enter a PIN.
Set up, install, and configure 28
background
Note: The application supports the following file types: PDF, JPEG, and TIFF. Other file types such as
DOCX and XLSX are supported in some printer models.
4 Click Save.
Creating folders
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Bookmarks > Add Folder, and then type a folder name.
Note: To limit access to the folder, enter a PIN.
3 Click Save.
Note: You can create folders or bookmarks inside a folder. To create a bookmark, see
“Creating bookmarks”
on page 28.
Managing contacts
1 From the home screen, touch Address Book.
2 Do one or more of the following:
To add a contact, touch
on top of the screen, and then touch Create Contact. If necessary, specify a
login method to allow application access.
To delete a contact, touch
on top of the screen, touch Delete Contacts, and then select the contact.
To edit contact information, touch the contact name.
To create a group, touch
on top of the screen, and then touch Create Group. If necessary, specify a
login method to allow application access.
To delete a group, touch
on top of the screen, touch Delete Groups, and then select the group.
To edit a contact group, touch GROUPS > select a group name >
> select the action you want to make.
3 Apply the changes.
Set up, install, and configure 29
background
Setting up and using the accessibility features
Activating Voice Guidance
From the home screen
1 In one motion and using one finger, slowly swipe left then up on the display until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Using two fingers, touch OK.
Note: If the gesture does not work, then apply more pressure.
From the keyboard
1 Press and hold the 5 key until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Press Tab to navigate the focus cursor to the OK button, and then press Enter.
Notes:
When Voice Guidance is activated, always use two fingers to select any item on the display.
Voice Guidance has limited language support.
Deactivating Voice Guidance
1 In one motion and using one finger, slowly swipe left then up on the display until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Using two fingers, do either of the following:
Tou ch Voice Guidance, then touch OK.
Tou ch Cancel.
Note: If the gesture does not work, then apply more pressure.
You can also deactivate Voice Guidance by doing either of the following:
Using two
fingers,
double tap the home screen.
Press the power button to put the printer in Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Navigating the screen using gestures
Notes:
Most of the gestures are applicable only when Voice Guidance is activated.
Enable Magnification to use the zoom and pan gestures.
Use a physical keyboard to type characters and adjust certain settings.
Set up, install, and configure 30
background
Gesture Function
Swipe left then up using one finger Launch Accessibility mode. Use the same gesture to exit Accessibility mode.
Note: This gesture is also applicable when the printer is in normal mode.
Doubletap using one finger Select an option or item on the screen.
Doubletap the home icon using two
fingers
Deactivate the Accessibility mode.
Tripletap using one finger Zoom in or zoom out text and images.
Swipe right or swipe down using one
finger
Move to the next item on the screen.
Swipe left or swipe up using one
finger
Move to the previous item on the screen.
Swipe up then down using one
finger
Move to the first item on the screen.
Pan Access parts of the zoomed image that are beyond the limit of the screen.
Note: Use two
fingers
to drag a zoomed image.
Swipe up then right using one finger Increase the volume.
Note: This gesture is also applicable when the printer is in normal mode.
Swipe down then right using one
finger
Decrease the volume.
Note: This gesture is also applicable when the printer is in normal mode.
Swipe up then left using one finger Exit an application and return to the home screen.
Swipe down then left using one
finger
Go back to the previous setting.
Using the onscreen keyboard
When the onscreen keyboard appears, do one or more of the following:
Touch a key to announce and type the character in the field.
Drag a finger across dierent characters to announce and type the character in the field.
Touch a text box using two fingers to announce the characters in the field.
Tou ch Backspace to delete characters.
Enabling Magnification mode
1 In one motion and using one
finger,
slowly swipe left then up on the display until you hear a voice message.
Note: For printer models without built-in speakers, use headphones to hear the message.
2 Using two fingers, do the following:
a Tou ch Magnification mode.
b Touc h OK.
Note: If the gesture does not work, then apply more pressure.
Set up, install, and configure 31
background
For more information on navigating a magnified screen, see “Navigating the screen using gestures” on page
30.
Adjusting the Voice Guidance speech rate
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Accessibility > Speech Rate.
2 Select the speech rate.
Adjusting the default headphone volume
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Accessibility.
2 Adjust the headphone volume.
Note: The volume resets to the default value after the user exits Accessibility mode or when the printer
wakes from Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Adjusting the default internal speaker volume
1 From the home screen, touch .
2 Adjust the volume.
Notes:
If Quiet Mode is enabled, then audible alerts are turned o. This setting also slows the printer
performance.
The volume resets to the default value after the user exits Accessibility mode or when the printer wakes
from Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Enabling spoken passwords or personal identification numbers
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Accessibility > Speak Passwords/PINs.
2 Enable the setting.
Set up, install, and configure 32
background
Setting up the printer to fax
Supported fax
Printer model Analog fax
etherFAX
1
Fax server
2
Fax over IP (FoIP)
3
CX532
CX635
XC2335
1
Needs a subscription. For more information, go to
https://www.etherfax.net/lexmark or contact the place where
you purchased the printer.
2
Needs a subscription for the fax server to work.
3
Needs an installed license bundle. For more information, contact the place where you purchased the printer.
Setting up the fax function using analog fax
Notes:
Some connection methods are applicable only in some countries or regions.
If the fax function is enabled and not fully set up, then the indicator light may blink red.
If you do not have a TCP/IP environment, then use the control panel to set up fax.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch cables or the printer
in the area shown while actively sending or receiving a fax.
Using the control panel
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > General Fax Settings.
2
Configure
the settings.
Set up, install, and configure 33
background
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > General Fax Settings.
3 Configure the settings.
4 Apply the changes.
Setting up the fax function using etherFAX
Notes:
The printer firmware must be updated to the latest version. For more information, see
“Updating
firmware” on page 55.
An appropriate license bundle must be installed in your printer. For more information, contact etherFAX.
Make sure that you have registered your printer to the etherFAX portal. For more information, go to
https://www.etherfax.net/lexmark.
The printer serial number is required on registration. To locate the serial number, see
“Finding the printer
serial number” on page 10.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > General Fax Settings.
Note: Fax Setup appears only if Fax Mode is set to Fax.
3 In the Fax Name field, type a unique name.
4 In the Fax Number field, enter the fax number that etherFAX provided.
5 From the Fax Transport menu, select etherFAX.
Notes:
This menu shows up only when more than one fax transport is available.
If the printer only has etherFAX installed, then it is automatically configured.
6 Apply the changes.
Set up, install, and configure 34
background
Setting up the fax function using fax server
Notes:
This feature lets you send fax messages to a fax service provider that supports email receiving.
This feature supports outgoing fax messages only. To support fax receive, make sure that you have a
devicebased fax, such as analog fax, etherFAX, or Fax over IP (FoIP), configured in your printer.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address
field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Fax.
3 From the Fax Mode menu, select Fax Server, and then click Save.
4 Click Fax Server Setup.
5 In the To Format field, type [#]@myfax.com, where [#] is the fax number and myfax.com is the fax
provider domain.
Notes:
If necessary,
configure
the Reply Address, Subject, or Message
fields.
To let the printer receive fax messages, enable the devicebased fax receive setting. Make sure that
you have a devicebased fax configured.
6 Click Save.
7 Click Fax Server E
mail Settings, and then do either of the following:
Enable Use E
mail SMTP Server.
Note: If the Email SMTP settings are not configured, then see
“Configuring the email SMTP settings
on page 39.
Configure the SMTP settings. For more information, contact your email service provider.
8 Apply the changes.
Setting up fax using a standard telephone line
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see
“Supported
fax” on page 33.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not use the fax feature during a
lightning storm.
Set up, install, and configure 35
background
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
Setup 1: Printer is connected to a dedicated fax line
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable to the line port of the printer.
2 Connect the other end of the cable to an active analog wall jack.
Notes:
You can set the printer to receive faxes automatically (set Auto Answer to On) or manually (set Auto
Answer to O).
If you want to receive faxes automatically, then set the printer to pick up on a specified number of rings.
Setup 2: Printer is sharing the line with an answering machine
Note: If you subscribe to a distinctive ring service, then make sure that you set the correct ring pattern for
the printer. Otherwise, the printer does not receive faxes even if you have set it to receive faxes
automatically.
Set up, install, and configure 36
background
Connected to dierent wall jacks
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable to the line port of the printer.
2 Connect the other end of the cable to an active analog wall jack.
Notes:
If you have only one telephone number on your line, then set the printer to receive faxes automatically.
Set the printer to pick up calls two rings after the answering machine. For example, if the answering
machine picks up calls after four rings, then set the printer Rings to Answer setting to 6.
Setting up fax in countries or regions with
dierent
telephone wall jacks
and plugs
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see
“Supported
fax” on page 33.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not set up this product or make
any electrical or cabling connections, such as the power cord, fax feature, or telephone, during a
lightning storm.
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, do not use the fax feature during a
lightning storm.
Set up, install, and configure 37
background
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of fire, use only a 26 AWG or larger
telecommunications (RJ-11) cord when connecting this product to the public switched telephone
network. For users in Australia, the cord must be approved by the Australian Communications and Media
Authority.
The standard wall jack adopted by most countries or regions is RJ11. If the wall jack or equipment in your facility
is not compatible with this type of connection, then use a telephone adapter. An adapter for your country or
region may not come with your printer, and you may need to purchase it separately.
There may be an adapter plug installed in the telephone port of the printer. Do not remove the adapter plug
from the telephone port of the printer if you are connecting to a serial or cascaded telephone system.
Part name Part number
Lexmark adapter plug 40X8519
Connecting the printer to a nonRJ11 wall jack
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable to the line port of the printer.
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the RJ11 adapter, and then connect the adapter to the wall jack.
3 If you want to connect another device with a nonRJ11 connector to the same wall jack, then connect it
directly to the telephone adapter.
Set up, install, and configure 38
background
Connecting to a distinctive ring service
A distinctive ring service lets you have multiple telephone numbers on one telephone line. Each telephone
number is assigned a dierent ring pattern.
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see
“Supported
fax” on page 33.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Admin Controls >
Answer On.
2 Select a ring pattern.
Setting the fax date and time
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Preferences > Date and Time >
Configure
.
2 Configure the settings.
Configuring
daylight saving time
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Preferences > Date and Time >
Configure
.
2 In the Time Zone menu, touch (UTC+user) Custom.
3 Tou ch UTC (GMT) Oset, and then configure the settings.
Configuring the fax speaker settings
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Speaker Settings.
2 Do the following:
Set Speaker Mode to Always On.
Set Speaker Volume to High.
Enable Ringer Volume.
Configuring the e
mail SMTP settings
Configure
the Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) settings to send a scanned document through e-mail. The
settings vary with each email service provider.
Before you begin, make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the network is connected to
the Internet.
Using the Embedded Web Server
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Set up, install, and configure 39
background
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Email.
3 From the Email Setup section,
configure
the settings.
Notes:
For more information, see the list of email service providers.
For email service providers that are not on the list, contact your provider and ask for the settings.
4 Click Save.
Using the Settings menu in the printer
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Email > Email Setup.
2 Configure the settings.
Notes:
For more information, see the list of
email service providers.
For email service providers that are not on the list, contact your provider and ask for the settings.
E
mail service providers
AOL Mail
Comcast Mail
Gmail
iCloud Mail
Mail.com
NetEase Mail (mail.126.com)
NetEase Mail (mail.163.com)
NetEase Mail (mail.yeah.net)
Outlook Live or Microsoft 365
QQ Mail
Sina Mail
Sohu Mail
Yah oo ! M a i l
Zoho Mail
Notes:
If you encounter errors using the settings provided, then contact your email service provider.
For email service providers that are not on the list, contact your provider.
Set up, install, and configure 40
background
AOL Mail
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.aol.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password App password
Note: To create an app password, go to the
AOL Account Security page, log
in to your account, and then click Generate app password.
Comcast Mail
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.comcast.net
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password
Note: Make sure that the Third Party Access Security setting is enabled on your account. For more
information, go to the
Comcast Xfinity Connect help page.
Gmail
TM
Note: Make sure that twostep verification is enabled on your Google account. To enable twostep
verification, go to the
Google Account Security page, log in to your account, and then from the “Signing in to
Google” section, click 2
Step Verification.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.gmail.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Set up, install, and configure 41
background
Setting Value
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password App password
Notes:
To create an app password, go to the
Google Account Security page, log
in to your account, and then from the “Signing in to Google” section, click
App passwords.
App passwords” shows only if twostep verification is enabled.
iCloud Mail
Note: Make sure that twostep
verification
is enabled on your account.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.mail.me.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password App password
Note: To create an app password, go to the
iCloud Account Management
page, log in to your account, and then from the Security section, click
Generate Password.
Mail.com
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.mail.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Set up, install, and configure 42
background
Setting Value
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password
NetEase Mail (mail.126.com)
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the NetEase
Mail home page, click Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.126.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization password
Note: The authorization password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
NetEase Mail (mail.163.com)
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the NetEase
Mail home page, click Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.163.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
DeviceInitiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization password
Note: The authorization password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
Set up, install, and configure 43
background
NetEase Mail (mail.yeah.net)
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the NetEase
Mail home page, click Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.yeah.net
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization password
Note: The authorization password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
Outlook Live or Microsoft 365
These settings apply to outlook.com and hotmail.com email domains, and Microsoft 365 accounts.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.oce365.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password or app password
Notes:
For accounts with twostep verification disabled, use your account
password.
For outlook.com or hotmail.com accounts with twostep verification
enabled, use an app password. To create an app password, go to the
Outlook Live Account Management page, and then log in to your
account.
Note: For additional setup options for business using Microsoft 365, go to the Microsoft 365 help page.
Set up, install, and configure 44
background
QQ Mail
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the QQ Mail
home page, click Settings > Account. From the POP3/IMAP/SMTP/Exchange/CardDAV/CalDAV Service
section, enable either POP3/SMTP service or IMAP/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.qq.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization code
Note: To generate an authorization code, from the QQ Mail home page, click
Settings > Account, and then from the
POP3/IMAP/SMTP/Exchange/CardDAV/CalDAV Service section, click
Generate authorization code.
Sina Mail
Note: Make sure that the POP3/SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the
Sina Mail home page, click Settings > More settings > User
end POP/IMAP/SMTP, and then enable
POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.sina.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Authorization code
Note: To create an authorization code, from the email home page, click
Settings > More settings > User
end POP/IMAP/SMTP, and then enable
Authorization code status.
Set up, install, and configure 45
background
Sohu Mail
Note: Make sure that the SMTP service is enabled on your account. To enable the service, from the Sohu
Mail home page, click Options > Settings > POP3/SMTP/IMAP, and then enable either IMAP/SMTP service
or POP3/SMTP service.
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.sohu.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 465
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Independent password
Note: The independent password is provided when IMAP/SMTP service or
POP3/SMTP service is enabled.
Yah o o! M a il
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.mail.yahoo.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password App password
Note: To create an app password, go to the
Yahoo Account Security page,
log in to your account, and then click Generate app password.
Zoho Mail
Setting Value
Primary SMTP Gateway smtp.zoho.com
Primary SMTP Gateway Port 587
Use SSL/TLS Required
Require Trusted Certificate Disabled
Set up, install, and configure 46
background
Setting Value
Reply Address You r e mail address
SMTP Server Authentication Login / Plain
Device
Initiated Email Use Device SMTP Credentials
Device UserID Yo u r e mail address
Device Password Account password or app password
Notes:
For accounts with twostep verification disabled, use your account
password.
For accounts with twostep verification enabled, use an app password. To
create an app password, go to the Zoho Mail Account Security page, log
in to your account, and then from the ApplicationSpecific Passwords
section, click Generate New Password.
Loading paper and specialty media
Setting the paper size and type
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type > select a paper
source.
2 Set the paper size and type.
Configuring Universal paper settings
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Media
Configuration
> Universal Setup.
2 Configure the settings.
Loading trays
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately.
Keep all other trays closed until needed.
1 Remove the tray.
Note: To avoid jams, do not remove trays while the printer is busy.
Set up, install, and configure 47
background
2 Adjust the guides to match the size of the paper that you are loading.
Note: Use the indicators on the bottom of the tray to position the guides.
Set up, install, and configure 48
background
3 Flex, fan, and align the paper edges before loading.
4 Load the paper stack with the printable side faceup.
For onesided printing, load letterhead faceup with the header toward the front of the tray.
For twosided printing, load letterhead facedown with the header toward the back of the tray.
Do not slide paper into the tray.
Make sure that the stack height is below the maximum paper fill indicator. Overfilling may cause paper
jams.
5 Insert the tray.
If necessary, set the paper size and type to match the paper loaded in the tray.
Loading the manual feeder
1 Adjust the edge guides to match the width of the paper that you are loading.
Note: Make sure that the guides
fit
snugly against the paper, but not too tight as to cause the paper to
buckle.
Set up, install, and configure 49
background
2 Load a sheet of paper with the printable side facedown.
Note: Make sure that the paper is loaded straight to avoid skewed or crooked print.
For onesided printing, load letterhead with the printable side facedown and the top edge entering the
printer
first.
For twosided printing, load letterhead with the printable side faceup and the top edge entering the
printer last.
Set up, install, and configure 50
background
Load envelope with the flap side up and against the right side of the paper guide.
3 Feed the paper until its leading edge gets pulled in.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid paper jams, do not force paper into the manual feeder.
Loading the multipurpose feeder
Note: The multipurpose feeder is available only if the optional 650-sheet duo tray is installed.
1 Open the multipurpose feeder.
Set up, install, and configure 51
background
2 Adjust the guide to match the size of the paper that you are loading.
3 Flex, fan, and align the paper edges before loading.
4 Load the paper.
For one-sided printing, load letterhead with the printable side facedown and the top edge entering the
printer first.
Set up, install, and configure 52
background
For two-sided printing, load letterhead with the printable side faceup and the top edge entering the
printer last.
Load envelopes with the flap side up and against the right side of the paper guide.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated
linings, or selfstick adhesives.
5 From the Paper menu in the control panel, set the paper size and type to match the paper loaded in the
multipurpose feeder.
Linking trays
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration
> select a paper source.
2 Set the same paper size and paper type for the trays that you are linking.
3 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance >
Configuration
Menu > Tray
Configuration
> Tray Linking.
4 Tou ch Automatic.
To unlink trays, make sure that no trays have the same paper size and paper type settings.
Warning—Potential Damage: The temperature of the fuser varies according to the specified paper type. To
avoid printing issues, match the paper type setting in the printer with the paper loaded in the tray.
Set up, install, and configure 53
background
Installing and updating software, drivers, and firmware
Installing the printer software
Notes:
The print driver is included in the software installer package.
For Macintosh computers with macOS version 10.7 or later, you do not need to install the driver to print
on an AirPrint-certified printer. If you want custom printing features, then download the print driver.
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.
From the software CD that came with your printer.
Go to
www.lexmark.com/downloads.
2 Run the installer, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.
Installing the fax driver
1 Go to
www.lexmark.com/downloads, search for your printer model, and then download the appropriate
installer package.
2 From your computer, click Printer Properties, and then navigate to the Configuration tab.
3 Select Fax, and then click Apply.
Adding printers to a computer
Before you begin, do one of the following:
Connect the printer and the computer to the same network. For more information on connecting the printer
to a network, see
“Connecting the printer to a WiFi network” on page 68.
Connect the computer to the printer. For more information, see
“Connecting a computer to the printer” on
page 70.
Connect the printer to the computer using a USB cable. For more information, see
Attaching cables” on
page 23.
Note: The USB cable is sold separately.
For Windows users
1 From a computer, install the print driver.
Note: For more information, see
“Installing the printer software” on page 54.
2 Open the printers folder, and then click Add a printer or scanner.
3 Depending on your printer connection, do one of the following:
Select a printer from the list, and then click Add device.
Click Show Wi
Fi Direct printers, select a printer, and then click Add device.
Click The printer that I want isn’t listed, and then from the Add Printer window, do the following:
a Select Add a printer using a TCP/IP address or hostname, and then click Next.
b In the “Hostname or IP address”
field,
type the printer IP address, and then click Next.
Set up, install, and configure 54
background
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
c Select a print driver, and then click Next.
d Select Use the print driver that is currently installed (recommended), and then click Next.
e Type a printer name, and then click Next.
f Select a printer sharing option, and then click Next.
g Click Finish.
For Macintosh users
1 From a computer, open Printers & Scanners.
2 Click
, and then select a printer.
3 From the Use menu, select a print driver.
Notes:
To use the Macintosh print driver, select either AirPrint or Secure AirPrint.
If you want custom printing features, then select the Lexmark print driver. To install the driver, see
“Installing the printer software” on page 54.
4 Add the printer.
Updating firmware
To enhance printer performance and fix issues, update the printer firmware regularly.
For more information on updating the firmware, contact your Lexmark representative.
To get the latest firmware, go to
www.lexmark.com/downloads, and then search for your printer model.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Device > Update Firmware.
3 Do either of the following:
Click Check for updates now > I agree, start update.
Upload the flash file.
a Browse to the
flash
file.
Note: Make sure that you have extracted the firmware zip file.
b Click Upload > Start.
Set up, install, and configure 55
background
Exporting or importing a configuration file
You can export the configuration settings of your printer into a text file, and then import the file to apply the
settings to other printers.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 From the Embedded Web Server, click Export Configuration or Import Configuration.
3 Follow the instructions on the screen.
4 If the printer supports applications, then do the following:
a Click Apps > select the application >
Configure
.
b Click Export or Import.
Adding available options in the print driver
For Windows users
1 Open the printers folder.
2 Select the printer you want to update, and then do either of the following:
For Windows 7 or later, select Printer properties.
For earlier versions, select Properties.
3 Navigate to the Configuration tab, and then select Update Now Ask Printer.
4 Apply the changes.
For Macintosh users
1 From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer, and then select Options & Supplies.
2 Navigate to the list of hardware options, and then add any installed options.
3 Apply the changes.
Installing hardware options
Available internal options
Intelligent storage drive (ISD)
Fonts
Simplified Chinese
Traditional Chinese
Japanese
Set up, install, and configure 56
background
Korean
Arabic
Mass storage
Hard disk
Licensed features
IPDS
Bar Code
Notes:
An ISD or a hard disk is required to activate Forms Merge and some IPDS features.
Some options are available only in some printer models. For more information, contact
customer
support.
Installing optional trays
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
3 Unpack the optional tray, and then remove all packing material.
4 Align the printer with the optional tray, and then lower the printer into place.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: If the printer weight is greater than 20 kg (44 lb), then it requires
two or more trained personnel to lift it safely.
Note: To avoid invalid
configuration,
when installing both the 550-sheet tray and 650-sheet tray, always
place the 550-sheet tray below the 650-sheet tray.
Set up, install, and configure 57
background
5 Connect the power cord to the printer, and then to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
6 Turn on the printer.
Add the tray in the print driver to make it available for print jobs. For more information, see
Adding available
options in the print driver” on page 56.
Installing the intelligent storage drive
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
3 Using a flathead screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board components or
connectors.
4 Unpack the intelligent storage drive (ISD).
Warning—Potential Damage: Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card.
Set up, install, and configure 58
background
5 Locate the ISD connector.
6 Insert the storage drive to the ISD connector.
Set up, install, and configure 59
background
7 Attach the controller board shield, and then install the screws.
8 Connect the power cord to the printer, and then to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
9 Turn on the printer.
Installing a printer hard disk
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.
1 Turn
o
the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
3 Remove the controller board shield.
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board components or
connectors.
Set up, install, and configure 60
background
4 Disconnect the fax interface cable from the controller board.
Set up, install, and configure 61
background
5 Remove the hard disk port cover from the controller board shield.
6 Unpack, and then assemble the hard disk.
Set up, install, and configure 62
background
7 Attach the hard disk to the controller board shield.
8 Connect the hard disk interface cable to the controller board.
Set up, install, and configure 63
background
9 Connect the fax interface cable to the controller board.
10 Attach the controller board shield, and then install the screws.
Set up, install, and configure 64
background
11 Connect the power cord to the printer, and then to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
12 Turn on the printer.
Installing the convenience stapler
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
3 Unpack the convenience stapler.
4 Remove the column covers.
Note: Do not throw away the column covers.
5 Insert the power supply through the printer, and then connect it to the convenience stapler.
Note: To avoid damaging the convenience stapler, use only the power supply that came with it.
Set up, install, and configure 65
background
6 Install the convenience stapler.
Set up, install, and configure 66
background
7 Position the power supply properly.
8 Attach the column cover.
Note: Secure the power supply properly.
9 Connect one end of the stapler power cord to the power supply, and then the other end to the electrical
outlet.
10 Connect one end of the printer power cord to the printer, and then the other end to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
11 Turn on the printer.
Set up, install, and configure 67
background
Networking
Wireless support
Printer model Machine type Model number Wireless
CX532adwe 7531 276 X
286
CX635adwe 676 X
686
XC2335 289
Connecting the printer to a WiFi network
Make sure that Active Adapter is set to Auto. From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network
Overview > Active Adapter.
Using the control panel
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > Setup On Printer Panel > Choose
Network.
2 Select a WiFi network, and then type the network password.
Note: For WiFinetworkready printer models, a prompt for WiFi network setup appears during initial
setup.
Using Lexmark Mobile Assistant
1 Depending on your mobile device, download the Lexmark Mobile Assistant application from either the
Google Play
TM
store or App Store online store.
2 From the printer home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > Setup Using Mobile App >
Printer ID.
3 From your mobile device, launch the application, and then accept the Terms of Use.
Note: If necessary, grant permissions.
4 Tap Connect to Printer > Go to Wi
Fi Settings.
5 Connect your mobile device to the printer wireless network.
6 Return to the application, and then tap Setup Wi-Fi Connection
7 Select a Wi-Fi network, and then type the network password.
8 Tap Done.
Set up, install, and configure 68
background
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using WiFi Protected Setup
(WPS)
Before you begin, make sure that:
The access point (wireless router) is WPS
certified
or WPScompatible. For more information, see the
documentation that came with your access point.
A wireless network adapter is installed in your printer. For more information, see the instructions that came
with the adapter.
Active Adapter is set to Auto. From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network Overview
> Active Adapter.
Using the Push Button method
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > Wi
Fi Protected Setup > Start Push
Button Method.
2 Follow the instructions on the display.
Using the personal identification number (PIN) method
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless > Wi
Fi Protected Setup > Start PIN
Method.
2 Copy the eightdigit WPS PIN.
3 Open a web browser, and then type the IP address of your access point in the address
field.
Notes:
To know the IP address, see the documentation that came with your access point.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
4 Access the WPS settings. For more information, see the documentation that came with your access point.
5 Enter the eightdigit PIN, and then save the changes.
Configuring
Wi
Fi Direct
Wi-Fi Direct
®
is a Wi-Fi-based peer-to-peer technology that allows wireless devices to connect directly to a Wi-
Fi Directenabled printer without using an access point (wireless router).
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wi-Fi Direct.
2 Configure the settings.
Enable Wi
Fi Direct—Enables the printer to broadcast its own WiFi Direct network.
Wi
Fi Direct Name—Assigns a name for the WiFi Direct network.
Wi
Fi Direct Password—Assigns the password for negotiating the wireless security when using the
peerto-peer connection.
Show Password on Setup Page—Shows the password on the Network Setup Page.
Auto-Accept Push Button Requests—Lets the printer accept connection requests automatically.
Note: Accepting pushbutton requests automatically is not secured.
Set up, install, and configure 69
background
Notes:
By default, the Wi-Fi Direct network password is not visible on the printer display. To show the password,
enable the password peek icon. From the home screen, touch Settings > Security > Miscellaneous >
Enable Password/PIN Reveal.
To know the password of the Wi-Fi Direct network without showing it on the printer display, from the
home screen touch Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
Connecting a mobile device to the printer
Before connecting your mobile device, make sure that WiFi Direct has been configured. For more information,
see
“Configuring WiFi Direct” on page 69.
Connecting using Wi
Fi Direct
Note: These instructions apply only to Android mobile devices.
1 From the mobile device, go to the settings menu.
2 Enable Wi
Fi, and then tap WiFi Direct.
3 Select the printer Wi-Fi Direct name.
4
Confirm
the connection on the printer control panel.
Connecting using Wi
Fi
1 From the mobile device, go to the settings menu.
2 Tap Wi
Fi, and then select the printer Wi-Fi Direct name.
Note: The string DIRECT-xy (where x and y are two random characters) is added before the Wi-Fi Direct
name.
3 Enter the Wi-Fi Direct password.
Connecting a computer to the printer
Before connecting your computer, make sure that WiFi Direct has been configured. For more information, see
“Configuring WiFi Direct” on page 69.
For Windows users
1 Open the printers folder, and then click Add a printer or scanner.
2 Click Show Wi-Fi Direct printers, and then select the printer WiFi Direct name.
3 From the printer display, take note of the eight-digit PIN of the printer.
4 Enter the PIN on the computer.
Note: If the print driver is not already installed, then Windows downloads the appropriate driver.
Set up, install, and configure 70
background
For Macintosh users
1 Click the wireless icon, and then select the printer WiFi Direct name.
Note: The string DIRECT-xy (where x and y are two random characters) is added before the Wi-Fi Direct
name.
2 Type the WiFi Direct password.
Note: Switch your computer back to its previous network after disconnecting from the Wi-Fi Direct network.
Deactivating the Wi
Fi network
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network Overview > Active Adapter > Standard
Network.
2 Follow the instructions on the display.
Checking the printer connectivity
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
2 Check the first section of the network setup page, and confirm that the status is connected.
If the status is not connected, then the LAN drop may be inactive, or the network cable may be
malfunctioning. Contact your administrator for assistance.
Set up, install, and configure 71
background
Secure the printer
Locating the security slot
The printer is equipped with a security lock feature. Attach a security lock compatible with most laptop
computers in the location shown to secure the printer in place.
Erasing printer memory
To erase volatile memory or buered data in your printer, turn o the printer.
To erase nonvolatile memory, device and network settings, security settings, and embedded solutions, do the
following:
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Out of Service Erase.
2 Tou ch t he Sanitize all information on nonvolatile memory check box, and then touch ERASE.
3 Tou ch Start initial setup wizard or Leave printer
oine
, and then touch Next.
4 Start the operation.
Note: This process also destroys the encryption key that is used to protect user data. Destroying the
encryption key makes the data irrecoverable.
Secure the printer 72
background
Erasing printer storage drive
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Out of Service Erase.
2 Depending on the storage drive that is installed on your printer, do either of the following:
For hard disk, touch the Sanitize all information on hard disk check box, touch ERASE, and then select
a method to erase data.
Note: The process to sanitize the hard disk can take from several minutes to more than an hour,
making the printer unavailable for other tasks.
For intelligent storage drive (ISD), touch Erase Intelligent Storage Drive, and then touch ERASE to erase
all user data.
3 Start the operation.
Restoring factory default settings
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Restore Factory Defaults.
2 In the Restore Settings menu, select the settings that you want to restore.
3 Tou ch RESTORE.
4 Follow the instructions on the display.
Statement of Volatility
Type of memory Description
Volatile memory The printer uses standard random access memory (RAM)
to buer temporarily user data during simple print and
copy jobs.
Nonvolatile memory The printer may use two forms of non-volatile memory:
EEPROM and NAND (flash memory). Both types store the
operating system, printer settings, and network
information. They also store scanner and bookmark
settings and embedded solutions.
Hard disk storage drive Some printers may have a hard disk drive installed. The
printer hard disk is designed for printer-specific
functionality. The hard disk lets the printer retain buered
user data from complex print jobs, form data, and font
data.
Intelligent storage drive (ISD) Some printers may have an ISD installed. ISD uses non-
volatile flash memory to store user data from complex
print jobs, form data, and font data.
Erase the content of any installed printer memory in the following circumstances:
The printer is decommissioned.
The printer hard disk or ISD is replaced.
The printer is moved to a dierent department or location.
The printer is serviced by someone from outside your organization.
Secure the printer 73
background
The printer is removed from your premises for service.
The printer is sold to another organization.
Note: To dispose a storage drive, follow the policies and procedures of your organization.
Secure the printer 74
background
Print
Printing from a computer
Note: For labels, card stock, and envelopes, set the paper size and type in the printer before printing the
document.
1 From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print dialog.
2 If necessary, adjust the settings.
3 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Mobile Print
Lexmark
TM
Mobile Print allows you to send documents and images directly to a supported Lexmark printer.
1 Open the document, and then send or share the document to Lexmark Mobile Print.
Note: Some thirdparty applications may not support the send or share feature. For more information, see
the documentation that came with the application.
2 Select a printer.
3 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device using Lexmark Print
Lexmark Print is a mobile printing solution for mobile devices running on Android
TM
version 6.0 or later. It lets
you send documents and images to network-connected printers and print management servers.
Notes:
Make sure that you download the Lexmark Print application from the Google Play store and enable it in
the mobile device.
Make sure that the printer and the mobile device are connected to the same network.
1 From your mobile device, select a document from the file manager.
2 Send or share the document to Lexmark Print.
Note: Some thirdparty applications may not support the send or share feature. For more information, see
the documentation that came with the application.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Print the document.
Print 75
background
Printing from a mobile device using Mopria Print Service
Mopria
®
Print Service is a mobile printing solution for mobile devices running on Android version 5.0 or later. It
allows you to print directly to any Mopriacertified printer.
Note: Make sure that you download the Mopria Print Service application from the Google Play store and
enable it in the mobile device.
1 From your Android mobile device, launch a compatible application or select a document from your file
manager.
2 Tap
> Print.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Tap
.
Printing from a mobile device using AirPrint
The AirPrint software feature is a mobile printing solution that allows you to print directly from Apple devices
to an AirPrintcertified printer.
Notes:
Make sure that the Apple device and the printer are connected to the same network. If the network has
multiple wireless hubs, then make sure that both devices are connected to the same subnet.
This application is supported only in some Apple devices.
1 From your mobile device, select a document from your
file
manager or launch a compatible application.
2 Tap
> Print.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Print the document.
Printing from a mobile device using WiFi Direct®
WiFi Direct
®
is a printing service that lets you print to any WiFi Directready printer.
Note: Make sure that the mobile device is connected to the printer wireless network. For more information,
see
“Connecting a mobile device to the printer” on page 70.
1 From your mobile device, launch a compatible application or select a document from your file manager.
2 Depending on your mobile device, do one of the following:
Tap
> Print.
Tap
> Print.
Tap
> Print.
3 Select a printer, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.
4 Print the document.
Print 76
background
Printing from a flash drive
1 Insert the flash drive.
Notes:
If you insert the flash drive when an error message appears, then the printer ignores the flash drive.
If you insert the
flash
drive while the printer is processing other print jobs, then Busy appears on the
display.
2 From the display, touch the document that you want to print.
If necessary, configure the print settings.
3 Print the document.
To print another document, touch USB Drive.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch the
flash
drive or
the printer in the area shown while actively printing, reading, or writing from the memory device.
Print 77
background
Supported flash drives and file types
Flash drives
Lexar JumpDrive S70 (16GB and 32GB)
SanDisk Cruzer Micro (16GB and 32GB)
PNY Attaché (16GB and 32GB)
Notes:
The printer supports highspeed
flash
drives with fullspeed standard. Lowspeed USB devices are not
supported.
Flash drives must support the File Allocation Table (FAT) system.
Devices formatted with New Technology File System (NTFS) or any other file system are not supported.
File types
Documents Images
PDF (version 1.7 or earlier)
HTML
Microsoft file formats (DOC, DOCX, XLS, XLSX, PPT, PPTX)
JPEG or JPG
TIFF or TIF
GIF
BMP
PNG
PCX
DCX
Configuring confidential jobs
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Security > Confidential Print Setup.
2 Configure the settings.
Setting Description
Max Invalid PIN Set the limit for entering an invalid PIN.
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name are deleted.
Confidential Job
Expiration
Set an individual expiration time for each held job before it is automatically deleted from
the printer memory, hard disk, or intelligent storage drive.
Note: A held job is either Confidential, Repeat, Reserve, or Verify.
Repeat Job Expiration Set the expiration time for print jobs that you want to repeat.
Verify Job Expiration Set the expiration time for printing a copy of a job for you to check its quality before
printing the remaining copies.
Reserve Job Expiration Set the expiration time for jobs that you want to store in the printer for printing later.
Require All Jobs to be
Held
Set the printer to hold all print jobs.
Print 78
background
Setting Description
Keep duplicate
documents
Set the printer to keep all documents with the same file name.
Printing confidential and other held jobs
For Windows users
1 With a document open, click File > Print.
2 Select a printer, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.
3 Click Print and Hold.
4 Select Use Print and Hold, and then assign a user name.
5 Select the print job type
(Confidential,
Repeat, Reserve, or Verify).
If you select Confidential, then secure the print job with a personal identification number (PIN).
6 Click OK or Print.
7 From the printer home screen, release the print job.
For confidential print jobs, touch Held jobs > select your user name > Confidential > enter the PIN >
select the print job >
configure
the settings > Print.
For other print jobs, touch Held jobs > select your user name > select the print job > configure the settings
> Print.
For Macintosh users
Using AirPrint
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.
2 Select a printer, and then from the drop-down menu following the Orientation menu, choose PIN Printing.
3 Enable Print with PIN, and then enter a fourdigit PIN.
4 Click Print.
5 From the printer home screen, release the print job. Touch Held jobs > select your computer name >
Confidential > enter the PIN > select the print job > Print.
Using the print driver
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.
2 Select a printer, and then from the drop-down menu following the Orientation menu, choose Print and Hold.
3 Choose
Confidential
Print, and then enter a fourdigit PIN.
4 Click Print.
5 From the printer home screen, release the print job. Touch Held jobs > select your computer name >
Confidential > select the print job > enter the PIN > Print.
Print 79
background
Printing a font sample list
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Print > Print Fonts.
2 To uch PCL Fonts or PS Fonts.
Printing a directory list
From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Print > Print Directory.
Placing separator sheets between copies
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Layout > Separator Sheets > Between Copies.
2 Print the document.
Canceling a print job
1 From the home screen, touch .
2 Select the job to cancel.
Note: You can also cancel a job by touching Job Queue.
Adjusting toner darkness
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality > Toner Darkness.
2 Select a setting.
Print 80
background
Copy
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Making copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
Note: To avoid a cropped image, make sure that the original document and output have the same paper
size.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy, and then specify the number of copies.
If necessary, adjust the copy settings.
3 Copy the document.
Note: To make a quick copy, from the home screen, touch
.
Copying photos
1 Place a photo on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Settings > Content > Content Type > Photo.
3 Tou ch Content Source, and then select the setting that best matches the original photo.
4 Copy the photo.
Copy 81
background
Copying on letterhead
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Copy From > select the size of the original document.
3 Tou ch Copy To, and then select the paper source that contains the letterhead.
If you loaded the letterhead into the multipurpose feeder, then touch Copy To > Multipurpose Feeder >
select a paper size > Letterhead.
4 Copy the document.
Copying on both sides of the paper
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Settings > Sides.
3 Tou ch 1 sided to 2 sided or 2 sided to 2 sided.
4 Copy the document.
Reducing or enlarging copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Settings > Scale > select a scale value.
Note: Changing the size of the original document or output after setting Scale restores the scale value to
Auto.
3 Copy the document.
Collating copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Collate > On [1,2,1,2,1,2].
3 Copy the document.
Placing separator sheets between copies
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the control panel, navigate to:
Copy > Settings > Separator Sheets > adjust the settings
3 Copy the document.
Copy 82
background
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Copy > Settings > Pages per Side.
3 Enable the setting, and then select the number per side and page orientation.
4 Copy the document.
Copying cards
1 Load a card on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Card Copy.
Note: If necessary, adjust the scan settings.
3 Tou ch Scan.
Note: If you want multiple copies of the card, then touch Print a Copy.
Creating a copy shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch Copy.
2 Configure the settings, and then touch
.
3 Create a shortcut.
Copy 83
background
E-mail
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Sending an e-mail
Before you begin, make sure that the SMTP settings are configured. For more information, see
“Configuring
the email SMTP settings” on page 39.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch E-mail, and then enter the needed information.
3 If necessary,
configure
the scan settings.
4 Send the e-mail.
Creating an e-mail shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch E
mail.
2 Configure the settings, and then touch
.
3 Create a shortcut.
E-mail 84
background
Fax
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Sending a fax
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
Using the control panel
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax, and then enter the needed information.
If necessary, adjust the settings.
3 Send the fax.
Using the computer
Before you begin, make sure that the fax driver is installed. For more information, see “Installing the fax driver”
on page 54.
For Windows users
1 From the document that you are trying to fax, open the Print dialog.
2 Select the printer, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.
Fax 85
background
3 Click Fax > Enable fax > Always display settings prior to faxing, and then enter the recipient number.
If necessary, configure other fax settings.
4 Send the fax.
For Macintosh users
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.
2 Select the printer that has
Fax added after its name.
3 In the To
field,
enter the recipient number.
If necessary, configure other fax settings.
4 Send the fax.
Scheduling a fax
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax > To > enter the fax number > Done.
3 Tou ch Send Time, configure the date and time, and then touch Done.
4 Send the fax.
Creating a fax destination shortcut
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Fax > To.
2 Enter the recipient number, and then touch Done.
3
Configure
the settings, and then touch
.
4 Create a shortcut.
Changing the fax resolution
Note: Make sure that fax is configured. For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax, and then enter the needed information.
3 Tou ch Settings > Resolution > select a setting.
4 Send the fax.
Fax 86
background
Adjusting the fax darkness
Note: Make sure that fax is
configured.
For more information, see the
Setting up the printer to fax section.
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Fax, and then enter the needed information.
3 Tou ch Settings > Darkness > adjust the setting.
4 Send the fax.
Printing a fax log
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is configured. For more information, see the Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Fax.
2 To uch Fax Job Log or Fax Call Log.
Blocking junk faxes
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is configured. For more information, see the
Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Admin Controls.
2 Set Block No Name Fax to On.
Holding faxes
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is
configured.
For more information, see the
Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Holding Faxes.
2 Select a mode.
Forwarding a fax
Note: Make sure that analog fax or etherFAX is
configured.
For more information, see the Setting up the
printer to fax section.
1 Create a destination shortcut.
a Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
Fax 87
background
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
b Click Shortcuts > Add Shortcut.
c Select a shortcut type, and then configure the settings.
Note: Take note of the shortcut number.
d Apply the changes.
2 Click Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax Receive Settings > Admin Controls.
3 In the Fax Forwarding menu, select Forward or Print and Forward.
4 In the Forward to menu, select the destination type and then type the shortcut number.
5 Apply the changes.
Fax 88
background
Scan
Using the automatic document feeder and scanner glass
Automatic document feeder (ADF) Scanner glass
Use the ADF for multiplepage or two-sided
documents.
Load an original document faceup. For multiplepage
documents, make sure to align the leading edge
before loading.
Make sure to adjust the ADF guides to match the width
of the paper that you are loading.
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents,
book pages, small items (such as postcards or
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media
(such as magazine clippings).
Place the document facedown in the corner with the
arrow.
Scanning to a computer
Before you begin, make sure that the computer and the printer are connected to the same network.
For Windows users
Using Lexmark ScanBack Utility
1 From the computer, run Lexmark ScanBack Utility, and then click Next.
Note: To download the utility, go to
www.lexmark.com/downloads.
2 Click Setup, and then add the printer IP address.
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
3 Click Close > Next.
4 Select the size of the original document, and then click Next.
5 Select a file format and scan resolution, and then click Next.
6 Type a unique scan profile name, and then click Next.
7 Browse to the location that you want to save the scanned document, create a file name, and then click
Next.
Note: To r eu s e t he sc a n
profile,
enable Create Shortcut, and then create a unique shortcut name.
Scan 89
background
8 Click Finish.
9 Load an original document into the automatic document feeder or on the scanner glass.
10 From the printer home screen, touch Scan
Profiles
> Scan to Computer, and then select a scan
profile.
Using Windows Fax and Scan
Note: Make sure that the printer is added to the computer. For more information, see
Adding printers to a
computer” on page 54.
1 Load an original document into the automatic document feeder or on the scanner glass.
2 From the computer, open Windows Fax and Scan.
3 Click New Scan, and then select a scanner source.
4 If necessary, change the scan settings.
5 Scan the document.
6 Click Save as, type a file name, and then click Save.
For Macintosh users
Note: Make sure that the printer is added to the computer. For more information, see
Adding printers to a
computer” on page 54.
1 Load an original document into the automatic document feeder or on the scanner glass.
2 From the computer, do either of the following:
Open Image Capture.
Open Printers & Scanners, and then select a printer. Click Scan > Open Scanner.
3 From the Scanner window, do one or more of the following:
Select the location that you want to save the scanned document.
Select the size of the original document.
To scan from the ADF, select Document Feeder from the Scan Menu or enable Use Document Feeder.
If necessary, configure the scan settings.
4 Click Scan.
Scanning to an FTP server
1 Load the original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch FTP, and then enter the needed information.
3 If necessary, configure other FTP settings.
4 Send the FTP job.
Scan 90
background
Creating an FTP shortcut
1 From the home screen, touch FTP.
2 Enter the FTP server address, and then touch
.
3 Create a shortcut.
Scanning to a network folder
1 Load the document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 From the home screen, touch Scan Center.
Note: The icon and name may have been changed. For more information, contact your administrator.
3 Do either of the following:
Select a destination.
Note: For SFTP, set the port number to 22.
Use a shortcut by touching
, and then selecting the shortcut from the list.
4 Scan the document.
Creating a network folder shortcut
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Shortcuts > Add Shortcut.
3 From the Shortcut Type menu, select Network Folder, and then configure the settings.
4 Apply the changes.
Scan 91
background
Scanning to a flash drive
1 Load an original document into the ADF tray or on the scanner glass.
2 Insert the flash drive.
3 Tou ch Scan to USB and adjust the settings if necessary.
Notes:
To save the scanned document to a folder, touch Scan to, select a folder, and then touch Scan Here.
If the USB Drive screen does not appear, then touch USB Drive on the control panel.
4 Scan the document.
Warning—Potential Damage: To avoid loss of data or printer malfunction, do not touch the
flash
drive or
the printer in the area shown while actively printing, reading, or writing from the memory device.
Scan 92
background
Use printer menus
Menu map
Device
Preferences
EcoMode
Remote Operator Panel
Notifications
Power Management
Anonymous Data Collection
Accessibility
Restore Factory Defaults
Maintenance
Home Screen Customization
1
Update Firmware
About this Printer
Print
Layout
Setup
Quality
Job Accounting
PDF
PostScript
PCL
Image
Paper
Tray Configuration Media Configuration
Copy Copy Defaults
Fax Fax Defaults
Email
Email Setup
Email Defaults
Web Link Setup
FTP FTP Defaults
USB Drive
Flash Drive Scan Flash Drive Print
Network/Ports
Network Overview
Wireless
WiFi Direct
AirPrint
Mobile Services Management
Ethernet
TCP/IP
SNMP
IPSec
802.1x
LPD Configuration
HTTP/FTP Settings
ThinPrint
USB
Restrict external network access
Security
Login Methods
Schedule USB Devices
Security Audit Log
Login Restrictions
Confidential Print Setup
Disk Encryption
Erase Temporary Data Files
Solutions LDAP Settings
Miscellaneous
Cloud Services Cloud Services Enrollment
1
Appears only in the Embedded Web Server.
2
Appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage drive is installed.
Use printer menus 93
background
Reports
Menu Settings Page
Device
Print
Shortcuts
Fax
Network
Troubleshooting Print Quality Test Pages Cleaning the Scanner
Forms Merge
2
Forms Merge
1
Appears only in the Embedded Web Server.
2
Appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage drive is installed.
Device
Preferences
Menu item Description
Display Language
[List of languages]
Set the language of the text that appears on the display.
Country/Region
[List of countries or regions]
Identify the country or region where the printer is configured
to operate.
Run initial setup
O*
On
Run the setup wizard.
Keyboard
Keyboard Type
[List of languages]
Select a language as a keyboard type.
Note: All the Keyboard Type values may not appear or may
require special hardware to appear.
Displayed information
Display Text 1 (IP Address*)
Display Text 2 (Date/Time*)
Custom Text 1
Custom Text 2
Specify the information to appear on the home screen.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 94
background
Menu item Description
Date and Time
Configure
Current Date and Time
Manually Set Date and Time
Date Format (MMDDYYYY*)
Time Format (12 hour A.M./P.M.*)
Time Zone
UTC (GMT)
Oset
DST Start
DST End
DST
Oset
Network Time Protocol
Enable NTP (On*)
NTP Server
Enable Authentication (None*)
Key ID
Password
Configure the printer date and time and network time protocol.
Notes:
MMDDYYYY is the U.S. factory default setting. DD-MM-
YYYY is the international factory default setting.
UTC (GMT) Oset, DST Start, DST End, and DST Oset
appear only when Time Zone is set to (UTC+user)
Custom.
Key ID and Password appear only when Enable
Authentication is set to MD5 key.
Paper Sizes
U.S.*
Metric
Specify the unit of measurement for paper sizes.
Note: The country or region selected in the initial setup
wizard determines the initial paper size setting.
Screen Brightness
20–100% (100*)
Adjust the brightness of the display.
Flash Drive Access
Disabled
Enabled*
Enable access to the flash drive.
Allow Background Removal
O
On*
Specify whether background removal is allowed.
Allow Custom Job scans
O
On*
Specify whether the Custom Job Scanning setting appears for
copy, scan, and fax.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an
intelligent storage drive is installed.
One Page Flatbed Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan any type of job involving the scanner
glass as a single page.
Note: The printer returns to the home screen after
performing a single flatbed scan instead of displaying
prompts.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 95
background
Menu item Description
Device Sounds
Mute All Sounds (O*)
Button Feedback (On*)
Volume (5*)
ADF Loaded Beep (On*)
Alarm Control (Single*)
Cartridge Alarm (O*)
Speaker Mode (Always
O*)
Ringer Volume
(O*)
Configure the sound settings of the printer.
Screen Timeout
5–300 seconds (60*)
Set the idle time in seconds before the display shows the home
screen, or before the printer logs out a user account
automatically.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Eco-Mode
Menu item Description
Print
Sides
1Sided*
2Sided
Specify whether to print on one side or both sides of the paper.
Print
Pages per Side
O*
2 pages per side
3 pages per side
4 pages per side
6 pages per side
9 pages per side
12 pages per side
16 pages per side
Print multiple page images on one side of a sheet of paper.
Print
Toner Darkness
1–5 (4*)
Determine the lightness or darkness of text images.
Print
Color Saver
O*
On
Reduce the amount of toner used to print graphics and images.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 96
background
Menu item Description
Copy
Sides
1 sided to 1 sided*
1 sided to 2 sided
2 sided to 1 sided
2 sided to 2 sided
Specify the scanning behavior based on the original
document.
Copy
Pages per Side
O*
2 Portrait pages
4 Portrait pages
2 Landscape pages
4 Landscape pages
Specify the scanning behavior based on the original
document.
Copy
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Determine the darkness of the scanned text images.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Remote Operator Panel
Menu item Description
External VNC Connection
Don’t Allow*
Allow
Connect an external Virtual Network Computing (VNC) client
to the remote control panel.
Authentication Type
None*
Standard Authentication
Set the authentication type when accessing the VNC client
server.
VNC Password Specify the password to connect to the VNC client server.
Note: This menu item appears only if Authentication Type is
set to Standard Authentication.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Notifications
Menu item Description
ADF Loaded Beep
O
On*
Enable a sound when loading paper into the ADF.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 97
background
Menu item Description
Alarm Control
O
Single*
Continuous
Set the number of times that the alarm sounds when the printer
requires user intervention.
Supplies
Show Supply Estimates
Show estimates*
Do not show estimates
Show the estimated status of the supplies.
Supplies
Cartridge Alarm
O*
Single
Continuous
Set the number of times that the alarm sounds when the toner
cartridge is low.
Supplies
Custom Supply Notifications
Configure notification settings when the printer requires user
intervention.
Note: This menu item appears only in the Embedded Web
Server.
E
mail Alerts Setup
Primary SMTP Gateway
Primary SMTP Gateway Port (25*)
Secondary SMTP Gateway
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port (25*)
SMTP Timeout (30 seconds*)
Reply Address
Always use SMTP default Reply Address
(O*)
Use SSL/TLS (Disabled*)
Require Trusted Certificate (On*)
SMTP Server Authentication (No authentication
required*)
DeviceInitiated Email (None*)
UserInitiated Email (None*)
Use Active Directory Device Credentials
(O*)
Device Userid
Device Password
Kerberos 5 REALM
NTLM Domain
Disable “SMTP server not set up” error
(O*)
Configure the printer to send email alerts to a list of contacts
when the printer requires user intervention.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 98
background
Menu item Description
Email Alerts Setup
Setup Email Lists and Alerts
Email List 1
Email List 2
Subject Text
Email Events
Specify the email addresses and enable the email alert
events.
Note: This menu item appears only in the Embedded Web
Server.
Error Prevention
Jam Assist
O
On*
Set the printer to flush automatically blank pages or pages with
partial prints after a jammed page is cleared.
Error Prevention
Auto Continue
Enabled
5–255 (5*)
Let the printer to continue processing or printing a job
automatically after clearing certain attendance conditions.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Auto Reboot
Reboot when idle
Reboot always*
Reboot never
Set the printer to restart when an error occurs.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Max Auto Reboots
1–20 (2*)
Set the number of automatic reboots that the printer can
perform.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Auto Reboot Window
1–525600 (720*)
Set the number of seconds before the printer performs an
automatic reboot.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Auto Reboot Counter
Show a readonly information of the reboot counter.
Error Prevention
Auto Reboot
Reset Auto Reboot Counter
Cancel
Continue
Reset the values of the Auto Reboot Counter.
Error Prevention
Display Short Paper Error
On
Autoclear*
Set the printer to show a message when a short paper error
occurs.
Note: Short paper refers to the size of the paper loaded.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 99
background
Menu item Description
Error Prevention
Page Protect
O*
On
Set the printer to process the entire page into the memory
before printing it.
Jam Content Recovery
Jam Recovery
O
On
Auto*
Set the printer to reprint jammed pages.
Jam Content Recovery
Scanner Jam Recovery
Job level
Page level*
Specify how to restart a scan job after resolving a paper jam.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Power Management
Menu item Description
Sleep Mode Profile
Print from Sleep Mode
Stay awake after printing
Enter Sleep Mode after printing*
Set the printer to stay awake or enter Sleep mode after
printing.
Sleep Mode Profile
Touch to Wake from Deep Sleep
O
On*
Wake the printer from Deep Sleep mode by touching the
printer display.
Timeouts
Sleep Mode
1–114 minutes (15*)
Set the idle time before the printer begins operating in Sleep
mode.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 100
background
Menu item Description
Timeouts
Hibernate Timeout
Disabled
1 hour
2 hours
3 hours
6 hours
1 day
2 days
3 days*
1 week
2 weeks
1 month
Set the time before the printer turns o.
Timeouts
Hibernate Timeout on Connection
Hibernate
Do Not Hibernate*
Set Hibernate Timeout to turn o the printer while an active
Ethernet connection exists.
Schedule Power Modes
Schedules
Add New Schedule
Schedule the printer when to enter Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Anonymous Data Collection
Menu item Description
Anonymous Data Collection
Device Usage and Performance
Information
None*
Send printer usage and performance information to Lexmark.
Note: Anonymous Data Send Time appears only when you set
Anonymous Data Collection to Device Usage and Performance
Information.
Anonymous Data Send Time
Start Time
Stop Time
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Accessibility
Menu item Description
Duplicate Key Strike Interval
0–5 (0*)
Set the interval in seconds during which the printer ignores
duplicate key presses on an attached keyboard.
Key Repeat Initial Delay
0.255 (1*)
Set the initial length of delay in seconds before a repeating key
starts repeating.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 101
background
Menu item Description
Key Repeat Rate
0.530 (30*)
Set the number of presses per second for a repeating key.
Prolong Screen Timeout
O*
On
Let the user remain in the same location and reset the Screen
Timeout timer when it expires instead of returning to the home
screen.
Headphone Volume
1–10 (5*)
Adjust the headphone volume.
Enable Voice Guidance When Headphone Is
Attached
O*
On
Enable Voice Guidance when a headphone is attached to the
printer.
Speak Passwords/PINs
O*
On
Set the printer to read out loud passwords or personal
identification numbers.
Speech Rate
Very Slow
Slow
Normal*
Fast
Faster
Very Fast
Rapid
Very Rapid
Fastest
Set the Voice Guidance speech rate.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Restore Factory Defaults
Menu item Description
Restore Settings
Restore all settings
Restore printer settings
Restore network settings
Restore fax settings
Restore app settings
Restore the printer factory default settings.
Use printer menus 102
background
Maintenance
Configuration Menu
Menu item Description
USB Configuration
USB PnP
1*
2
Change the USB driver mode of the printer to improve its
compatibility with a personal computer.
USB Configuration
USB Scan to Local
On*
O
Set whether the USB device driver enumerates as a USB
Simple device (single interface) or as a USB Composite device
(multiple interfaces).
USB Configuration
USB Speed
Full
Auto*
Set the USB port to run at full speed and disable its high-speed
capabilities.
Tray Conguration
Tray Linking
Automatic*
O
Set the printer to link the trays that have the same paper type
and paper size settings.
Tray Conguration
Show Tray Insert Message
O
Only for unknown sizes*
Always
Display a message that lets the user change the paper size and
paper type settings after inserting the tray.
Tray Conguration
Paper Prompts
Auto*
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Set the paper source that the user fills when a prompt to load
paper appears.
Note: For Multipurpose Feeder to appear, in the Paper menu,
set Configure MP to Cassette.
Tray Conguration
Envelope Prompts
Auto*
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Envelope
Set the paper source that the user fills when a prompt to load
envelope appears.
Note: For Multipurpose Feeder to appear, in the Paper menu,
set Configure MP to Cassette.
Tray Conguration
Action for Prompts
Prompt user*
Continue
Use current
Set the printer to resolve paper- or envelope-related change
prompts.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 103
background
Menu item Description
Tray Conguration
Multiple Universal Sizes
O*
On
Set the tray to support multiple universal paper sizes.
Reports
Menu Settings Page
Event Log
Event Log Summary
Print reports about printer menu settings, status, and event
logs.
Supply Usage And Counters
Clear Supply Usage History
Reset the supply usage history, such as number of pages and
days remaining, to the factory shipped level.
Supply Usage And Counters
ITM Reset
Reset the counter after installing a new supply item or
maintenance kit.
Supply Usage And Counters
Reset Maintenance Counter
Reset the counter after installing a new maintenance kit.
Supply Usage And Counters
Tiered Coverage Ranges
Adjust the amount of color coverage for each printing range.
Printer Emulations
PPDS Emulation
O*
On
Set the printer to recognize and use the PPDS data stream.
Printer Emulations
PS Emulation
O
On*
Set the printer to recognize and use the PS data stream.
Print Emulations
Use Native ISD Fonts
O*
On
Let the printer use the native fonts or free fonts in the intelligent
storage drive (ISD) for printing.
Note: This menu item appears only when an ISD is installed.
Printer Emulations
Enable Formsmerge
O
On*
Activate Forms Merge to store the forms into the hard disk or
ISD.
Notes:
The Forms Merge license must be installed.
This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD
is installed.
Printer Emulations
Enable Prescribe
O*
On
Activate Prescribe.
Note: The Prescribe license must be installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 104
background
Menu item Description
Printer Emulations
Emulator Security
Page Timeout
0–60 (60*)
Set the page time-out during emulation.
Printer Emulations
Emulator Security
Reset Emulator After Job
O*
On
Reset the emulator after a print job.
Printer Emulations
Emulator Security
Disable Printer Message Access
O
On*
Disable access to printer message during emulation.
Fax Configuration
Fax Low Power Support
Disable Sleep
Permit Sleep
Auto*
Set fax to enter Sleep mode whenever the printer determines
that it must.
Fax Configuration
Fax Storage Location
NAND
Disk*
Set the storage location for all faxes.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an
ISD is installed.
Print Configuration
Black Only Mode
O*
On
Print noncopy jobs in grayscale.
Print Configuration
Color Trapping
O
1
2*
3
4
5
Enhance the printed output to compensate for misregistration
in the printer.
Print Configuration
Font Sharpening
0–150 (24*)
Set a text point-size value below which the high-frequency
screens are used when printing font data.
For example, if the value is 24, then all fonts sized 24 points or
less use the highfrequency screens.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 105
background
Menu item Description
Device Operations
Quiet Mode
O*
On
Set the printer to operate in Quiet Mode.
Note: Enabling this setting slows down the overall
performance of the printer.
Device Operations
Safe Mode
O*
On
Set the printer to operate in a special mode, in which it attempts
to continue oering as much functionality as possible, despite
known issues.
For example, when set to On, and the duplex motor is
nonfunctional, the printer performs onesided printing of the
documents even if the job is twosided printing.
Device Operations
Minimum Copy Memory
80 MB*
100 MB
Set the minimum memory allocation for storing copy jobs.
Device Operations
Clear Custom Status
Erase userdefined strings for the Default or Alternate custom
messages.
Device Operations
Clear all remotelyinstalled messages
Erase messages that were remotely installed.
Device Operations
Automatically Display Error Screens
O
On*
Show existing error messages on the display after the printer
remains inactive on the home screen for a length of time.
Device Operations
Honor orientation on fast path copy
O*
On
Enable the printer to use the orientation setting under the Copy
menu when sending quick copy jobs.
Toner patch sensor setup
Calibration frequency preference
Disabled
Fewest color adjustments
Fewer color adjustments
Normal*
Better color accuracy
Best color accuracy
Set the printer to put down the correct amount of toner to
maintain color consistency.
Toner patch sensor setup
Full calibration
Run the full color calibration.
Toner patch sensor setup
Print TPS information page
Print a diagnostic page that contains information on toner patch
sensor calibration.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 106
background
Menu item Description
App Configuration
LES Applications
O
On*
Enable Lexmark Embedded Solutions (LES) applications.
Scanner Configuration
Scanner Manual Registration
Print Quick Test
Print a Quick Test target page.
Note: Make sure that the margin spacing on the target page
is uniform all the way around the target. If it is not, then the
printer margins must be reset.
Scanner Configuration
Scanner Manual Registration
Front ADF Registration
Rear ADF Registration
Flatbed Registration
Manually register the flatbed and ADF after replacing the ADF,
scanner glass, or controller board.
Scanner Configuration
Reset Maintenance Counter
Reset the counter after replacing the ADF maintenance kit.
Scanner Configuration
Edge Erase
Flatbed Edge Erase (3*)
ADF Edge Erase (3*)
Set the size, in millimeters, of the noprint area around an ADF
or flatbed scan job.
Scanner Configuration
ADF Deskew
ADF Electronic Deskew (Auto*)
Set the printer to perform ADF mechanical skew adjustment.
Scanner Configuration
Disable Scanner
No*
Ye s
ADF Only
Disable the scanner when it is not working properly.
Scanner Configuration
Ti Byte Order
CPU Endianness*
Little Endian
Big Endian
Set the byte order of a TIFFformatted scan output.
Scanner Configuration
Exact
Ti
Rows Per Strip
On*
O
Set the RowsPerStrip tag value of a TIFFformatted scan output.
Scanner Configuration
Scanner Glass Cleaning Threshold
1000–30000 (1*)
Set the number of scans before the user is prompted to clean
the scanner glass.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 107
background
Out of Service Erase
Menu item Description
Out of Service Erase
Memory Last Sanitized
ISD last erased
Show a readonly information on when the printer memory or
storage drive was last erased.
Note: ISD last erased appears only when an intelligent
storage drive is installed.
Out of Service Erase
Sanitize all information on nonvolatile memory
Erase all printer and network settings
Erase all apps and app settings
Erase all shortcuts and shortcut settings
Erase Intelligent Storage Drive
Clear all information on nonvolatile memory and on the storage
drive.
Note: Erase Intelligent Storage Drive appears only when an
ISD is installed.
Home Screen Customization
Note: This menu appears only in the Embedded Web Server.
Menu Description
Copy
E-mail
Fax
Held Faxes
Release Held Faxes
Status/Supplies
Job Queue
Settings
Change Language
Address Book
Bookmarks
Held Jobs
USB Drive
FTP
Scan Profiles
Lock Device
Scan Center
Card Copy
Shortcut Center
Specify which icons to show on the home screen.
Update
firmware
Menu item Description
Current Version Show the current firmware version installed on the printer.
Check for updates now Check for firmware updates.
Auto check for updates Set the printer to check for firmware updates automatically.
Use printer menus 108
background
About this Printer
Menu item Description
Asset Tag Specify the identity of the printer. The maximum length is 32 characters.
Printer’s Location Specify the printer location. The maximum length is 63 characters.
Contact Specify the contact information for the printer. The maximum length is 63
characters.
Firmware Version Show the firmware version installed on the printer.
Engine Show the engine number of the printer.
Serial Number Show the serial number of the printer.
Export Configuration File to
USB
Export the configuration file to a flash drive.
Export Compressed Logs to
USB
Export the compressed log files to a flash drive.
Send Logs Send printer log information to Lexmark.
Print
Layout
Menu item Description
Sides
1Sided*
2Sided
Specify whether to print on one side or both sides of the paper.
Flip Style
Long Edge*
Short Edge
Determine which side of the paper is bound when performing twosided printing.
Blank Pages
Print
Do Not Print*
Print blank pages that are included in a print job.
Collate
O (1,1,1,2,2,2)
On (1,2,1,2,1,2)*
Keep the pages of a print job stacked in sequence, particularly when printing multiple
copies of the job.
Separator Sheets
None*
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 109
background
Menu item Description
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Pages per Side
O*
2 pages per side
3 pages per side
4 pages per side
6 pages per side
9 pages per side
12 pages per side
16 pages per side
Print multiple page images on one side of a sheet of paper.
Pages per Side Ordering
Horizontal*
Reverse Horizontal
Vertical
Reverse Vertical
Specify the positioning of multiple page images when using the Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Orientation
Auto*
Landscape
Portrait
Specify the orientation of multiple page images when using the Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Border
None*
Solid
Print a border around each page image when using the Pages per Side menu.
Copies
1–9999 (1*)
Specify the number of copies for each print job.
Print Area
Normal*
Whole Page
Set the printable area on a sheet of paper.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Setup
Menu item Description
Printer Language
PCL Emulation
PS Emulation*
Set the printer language.
Note: Setting a printer language default does not prevent a software
program from sending print jobs that use another printer language.
Job Waiting
O*
On
Preserve print jobs requiring supplies so that jobs not requiring the missing
supplies can print.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent
storage drive (ISD) is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 110
background
Menu item Description
Job Hold Timeout
0–255 (30*)
Set the time in seconds that the printer waits for user intervention before
it holds jobs that require unavailable resources.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Printer Usage
Max Speed
Max Yield*
Determine how the color imaging kit operates during printing.
Notes:
When set to Max Yield, the color imaging kit slows or stops while
printing groups of black-only pages.
When set to Max Speed, the color imaging kit always runs while
printing, whether color or black pages are being printed.
Low
Speed Printer Usage
Max Speed
Max Yield*
Determine how the color imaging kit operates during lowspeed printing.
Notes:
When set to Max Yield, the color imaging kit slows or stops while
printing groups of black-only pages.
When set to Max Speed, the color imaging kit always runs while
printing, whether color or black pages are being printed.
This setting only changes printer behavior when the print engine is
running at a 25 pages per minute process speed. It has no eect
when the print engine is running at faster process speeds.
Download Target
RAM*
Disk
Specify where to save all permanent resources that have been
downloaded to the printer.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Resource Save
O*
On
Determine what the printer does with downloaded resources when it
receives a job that requires more than the available memory.
Notes:
When set to O, the printer retains downloaded resources only until
memory is needed. Resources associated with the inactive printer
language are deleted.
When set to On, the printer preserves all the permanent
downloaded resources across all language switches. When
necessary, the printer shows memory full messages instead of
deleting permanent resources.
Print All Order
Alphabetical*
Newest First
Oldest First
Specify the order when you choose to print all held and confidential jobs.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 111
background
Quality
Menu item Description
Print Mode
Black and White
Color*
Set how the printer generates color content.
Print Resolution
4800 CQ*
1200 dpi
Set the resolution for the printed output.
Note: 4800 CQ provides highquality output at maximum speed.
Toner Darkness
1 to 5 (4*)
Determine the lightness or darkness of text images.
Halftone
Normal*
Detail
Enhance the printed output to have smoother lines with sharper edges.
Color Saver
O*
On
Reduce the amount of toner used to print graphics and images.
Note: When set to On, this setting overrides the value of the Toner Darkness
setting.
RGB Brightness
6 to 6 (0*)
Adjust the brightness of every RGB and gray object on the page.
Note: This setting does not
aect
files
where CMYK color
specifications
are
used.
RGB Contrast
6 to 6 (0*)
Adjust the contrast of every RGB and gray object on a page.
Note: This setting does not aect files where CMYK color specifications are
used.
RGB Saturation
0 to 5 (0*)
Preserve the black and white values while adjusting the color values of every
object on the page.
Note: This setting does not aect files where CMYK color specifications are
used.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye ll o w ( 0 * )
Black (0*)
Adjust the amount of toner that is used for each color.
Color Balance
Reset Defaults
Reset all color settings to their default values.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 112
background
Menu item Description
Color Correction
O
Auto*
Manual
Modify the color settings used to print documents.
Notes:
O sets the printer to receive the color correction from the software.
Auto sets the printer to apply dierent color profiles to each object on the
printed page.
Manual allows the customization of the RGB or CMYK color conversions
applied to each object on the printed page.
Color Samples
Print Color Samples
Print sample pages for each of the RGB and CMYK color conversion tables used
in the printer.
Color Adjust Calibrate the printer to adjust color variations in the printed output.
Spot Color Replacement
Set Custom CMYK
Assign specific CMYK values to twenty named spot colors.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Job Accounting
Menu item Description
Job Accounting
O*
On
Set the printer to create a log of the print jobs that it receives.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Accounting Log Frequency
Daily
Weekly
Monthly*
Specify how often the printer creates a log file.
Log Action at End of Frequency
None*
Email Current Log
Email & Delete Current Log
Post Current Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Specify how the printer responds when the frequency threshold expires.
Note: The value defined in Accounting Log Frequency determines when this
action is triggered.
Log Near Full Level
O
On (5)*
Specify the maximum size of the log file before the printer executes the Log
Action at Near Full.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 113
background
Menu item Description
Log Action at Near Full
None*
Email Current Log
Email & Delete Current Log
Email & Delete Oldest Log
Post Current Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Post & Delete Oldest Log
Delete Current Log
Delete Oldest Log
Delete All But Current
Delete All Logs
Specify how the printer responds when the hard disk or ISD is nearly full.
Note: The value
defined
in Log Near Full Level determines when this action
is triggered.
Log Action at Full
None*
Email & Delete Current Log
Email & Delete Oldest Log
Post & Delete Current Log
Post & Delete Oldest Log
Delete Current Log
Delete Oldest Log
Delete All But Current
Delete All Logs
Specify how the printer responds when hard disk or ISD usage reaches the
maximum limit (100MB).
URL to Post Log Specify where the printer posts job accounting logs.
E
mail Address to Send Logs Specify the email address to which the printer sends job accounting logs.
Log File Prefix Specify the prefix for the log files.
Note: The current host name
defined
in the TCP/IP menu is used as the
default log file prefix.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
PDF
Menu item Description
Scale To Fit
O*
On
Scale the page content to fit the selected paper size.
Annotations
Print
Do Not Print*
Specify whether to print annotations in the PDF.
Print PDF Error
O
On*
Enable the printing of PDF error.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 114
background
PostScript
Menu item Description
Print PS Error
O*
On
Print a page that describes the PostScript® error.
Note: When an error occurs, processing of the job stops, the printer
prints an error message, and the rest of the print job is flushed.
Minimum Line Width
1–30 (2*)
Set the minimum stroke width.
Note: Jobs printed in 1200 dpi use the value directly.
Lock PS Startup Mode
O
On*
Disable the SysStart file.
Image Smoothing
O*
On
Enhance the contrast and sharpness of lowresolution images.
Note: This setting has no
eect
on images with a resolution of 300 dpi or
higher.
Font Priority
Resident*
Flash/Disk
Establish the font search order.
Notes:
Resident sets the printer to search its memory for the requested font
before searching the hard disk or intelligent storage drive (ISD).
Flash/Disk sets the printer to search the hard disk or ISD for the
requested font before searching the printer memory.
This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Wait Timeout
O
On* (40 seconds)
Enable the printer to wait for more data before canceling a print job.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
PCL
Menu item Description
Font Source
Resident*
Disk
Download
Flash
Font Card
All
Select the source which contains the default font selection.
Notes:
Disk and Flash appear only when a non-defective, non-protected
hard disk or intelligent storage drive (ISD) that contains fonts is
installed.
Download appears only if downloaded fonts exist in the printer
memory.
Font Card appears only when an ISD is installed.
Font Name
[List of available fonts] (Courier*)
Select a font from the specified font source.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 115
background
Menu item Description
Symbol Set
[List of available symbol set] (10U
PC8*)
Specify the symbol set for each font name.
Note: A symbol set is a set of alphabetic and numeric characters,
punctuation, and special symbols. Symbol sets support the
dierent
languages or specific programs such as math symbols for scientific text.
Pitch
0.08–100.00 (10.00*)
Specify the pitch for fixed or monospaced fonts.
Note: Pitch refers to the number of
fixed
space characters in a horizontal
inch of type.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Reverse Portrait
Reverse Landscape
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.
Lines per Page
1–255
Specify the number of lines of text for each page printed through the PCL®
data stream.
Notes:
This menu item activates vertical escapement that causes the
selected number of requested lines to print between the default
margins of the page.
60 is the U.S. factory default setting. 64 is the international factory
default setting.
PCL5 Minimum Line Width
1–30 (2*)
Set the initial minimum stroke width.
PCLXL Minimum Line Width
1–30 (2*)
A4 Width
198 mm*
203 mm
Set the width of the logical page on A4size paper.
Note: Logical page is the space on the physical page where data is
printed.
Auto CR after LF
On
O*
Set the printer to perform a carriage return after a line feed control
command.
Note: Carriage return is a mechanism that commands the printer to move
the position of the cursor to the first position on the same line.
Auto LF after CR
On
O*
Set the printer to perform a line feed after a carriage return control
command.
Tray Renumber
Assign Tray [x]
Assign Manual Paper
Assign Manual Envelope
Configure the printer to work with a dierent print driver or custom
application that uses a dierent set of source assignments to request a
given paper source.
Tray Renumber
View Factory Defaults
Show the factory default value assigned for each paper source.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 116
background
Menu item Description
Tray Renumber
Restore Defaults
Restore the tray renumber values to their factory defaults.
Print Timeout
O
On* (90 seconds)
Set the printer to end a print job after it has been idle for the specified
amount of time.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Image
Menu item Description
Auto Fit
On
O*
Select the best available paper size and orientation setting for an image.
Note: When set to On, this menu item overrides the scaling and orientation
settings for the image.
Invert
O*
On
Invert bitonal monochrome images.
Note: This menu item does not apply to GIF or JPEG image formats.
Scaling
Anchor Top Left
Best Fit*
Anchor Center
Fit Height/Width
Fit Height
Fit Width
Adjust the image to fit the printable area.
Note: When Auto Fit is set to On, Scaling is automatically set to Best Fit.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Reverse Portrait
Reverse Landscape
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 117
background
Paper
Tray Conguration
Menu item Description
Default Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Set the paper source for all print jobs.
Paper Size/Type
Tray [x]
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Specify the paper size or paper type loaded in each paper source.
Substitute Size
O
Letter/A4
All Listed*
Set the printer to substitute a specified paper size if the requested size is not
loaded in any paper source.
Notes:
O
prompts the user to load the required paper size.
All Listed allows all available substitutions.
Configure MP
Cassette*
Manual
First
Determine the behavior of the multipurpose feeder.
Notes:
Cassette configures the multipurpose feeder as the automatic paper
source.
Manual sets the multipurpose feeder only for manual-feed print jobs.
First configures the multipurpose feeder as the primary paper source.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Media Configuration
Universal Setup
Menu item Description
Units of Measure
Inches
Millimeters
Specify the unit of measurement for the universal paper.
Note: Inches is the U.S. factory default setting. Millimeters is the
international factory default setting.
Portrait Width
3–52 inches (8.5*)
76–1321 mm (216*)
Set the portrait width of the universal paper.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 118
background
Menu item Description
Portrait Height
3–52 inches (14*)
76.2–1321 mm (356*)
Set the portrait height of the universal paper.
Feed Direction
Short Edge*
Long Edge
Set the printer to pick paper from the short edge or long edge
direction.
Note: Long Edge appears only when the longest edge is shorter
than the maximum width supported.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Custom Scan Sizes
Menu item Description
Custom Scan Size [x]
Scan Size Name
Width
1–8.5 inches (8.5*)
25.4–215.9 mm (215.9*)
Height
1–25 inches (11*)
25.4–635 mm (279.4*)
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
2 scans per side
O*
On
Assign a scan size name and configure the scan settings.
Use printer menus 119
background
Media Types
Menu item Description
Plain Paper
Card Stock
Recycled
Glossy
Labels
Vinyl Labels
Bond
Envelope
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Light Paper
Heavy Paper
Rough/Cotton
Custom Type [X]
Specify the texture, weight, and orientation of the paper.
Copy
Copy Defaults
Menu item Description
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt/ Ph ot o *
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the source of the original document.
Sides
1 sided to 1 sided*
1 sided to 2 sided
2 sided to 1 sided
2 sided to 2 sided
Specify the scanning behavior based on the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 120
background
Menu item Description
Separator Sheets
None*
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Specify whether to insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Color
O
On*
Auto
Set the printer to generate color output from a scan job.
Pages per Side
O*
2 Portrait pages
4 Portrait pages
2 Landscape pages
4 Landscape pages
Specify the number of page images to print on one side of a sheet of paper.
Print Page Borders
O*
On
Place a border around each image when printing multiple pages on a single
page.
Collate
O [1,1,1,2,2,2]
On [1,2,1,2,1,2]*
Print multiple copies in sequence.
“Copy from” Size
[List of paper sizes]
Set the paper size of the original document.
Note: Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory
default setting.
“Copy to” Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Auto Size Match
Specify the paper source for the copy job.
Temp eratur e
4 to 4 (0*)
Specify whether to generate a cooler or warmer output.
Darkness
1 to 9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Number of Copies
1–9999 (1*)
Specify the number of copies.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 121
background
Menu item Description
Header/Footer
Left Header
Middle Header
Right Header
Left Footer
Middle Footer
Right Footer
Specify the header or footer information on the scanned image.
Overlay
Confidential
Copy
Draft
Urgent
Custom
O*
Specify the overlay text to print on each copy.
Custom overlay Type the text for the Custom choice in the Overlay menu.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*
Magenta (0*)
Ye ll o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold(128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
Contrast
Best for content*
0–5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document .
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 122
background
Menu item Description
Auto Center
O*
On
Align the content at the center of the page.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the original document.
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Scan the original document from edge to edge.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness of the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Allow Color Copies
O
On*
Print copies in color.
Allow Priority Copies
O
On*
Interrupt a print job to make copies.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the specified
settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Allow Save as Shortcut
O
On*
Save copy settings as a shortcut.
Adjust ADF Skew
O
On*
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are scanned
from the ADF.
Sample copy
O*
On
Print a sample copy to check the quality before printing the remaining copies.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 123
background
Fax
Fax Defaults
Fax Mode
Menu item Description
Fax Mode
Fax
Fax Server
Disabled
Select a fax mode.
Note: Depending on your printer model, the factory default
setting may vary.
Fax Setup
General Fax settings
Menu item Description
Fax Name Specify your fax ID.
Fax Number Specify your fax number.
Fax ID
Fax Name
Fax Number*
Set the fax ID to use during fax negotiation.
Enable Manual Fax
O*
On
Turn on the manual fax function in the printer.
Notes:
This menu item requires a line splitter and a telephone handset.
Use a regular telephone line to answer an incoming fax job and to dial a
fax number.
To go directly to the manual fax function, touch # and 0 on the keypad.
Memory Use
All receive
Mostly receive
Equal*
Mostly send
All send
Set the amount of internal printer memory allocated for faxing.
Note: This menu item prevents memory
buer
conditions and failed faxes.
Cancel Faxes
Allow*
Don't Allow
Cancel outgoing or incoming faxes.
Fax Number Masking
O*
From Left
From Right
Specify the format for masking an outgoing fax number.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 124
background
Menu item Description
Digits to Mask
0–58 (0*)
Specify the number of digits to mask in an outgoing fax number.
Enable Line Connected
Detection
O
On*
Determine whether a telephone line is connected to the printer.
Note: Events are detected immediately.
Enable Line In Wrong Jack
Detection
O
On*
Determine whether a telephone line is connected to the correct port on the
printer.
Note: Events are detected immediately.
Enable Extension in Use
Support
O
On*
Determine whether a telephone line is used by another device, such as another
phone on the same line.
Note: Events are detected immediately.
Optimize Fax Compatibility Configure the printer fax functionality for optimal compatibility with other fax
machines.
Fax Transport
T.38
Analog
G.711
etherFAX
Set the fax transport method.
Note: This menu item appears only if an etherFAX or Fax over IP (FoIP) license
bundle is installed in the printer.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
HTTPS Fax Settings
Note: This menu appears only if Fax Transport is set to etherFAX.
Menu item Description
HTTPS service URL Specify the etherFAX service URL.
HTTPS Proxy Specify a proxy server URL.
HTTPS Proxy User Specify the user name and password for the proxy server.
HTTPS Proxy Password
Fax Send Encryption
Disabled
Enabled*
Required
Enable encryption for outgoing fax messages.
Fax Receive Encryption
Disabled
Enabled*
Required
Enable encryption for incoming fax messages.
HTTPS Fax Status Show the etherFAX communication status.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 125
background
Fax Send Settings
Menu item Description
Resolution
Standard*
Fine
Super Fine
Ultra Fine
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Note: A higher resolution increases fax transmission time and requires more
memory.
Original Size
[List of paper sizes] (Mixed
Sizes*)
Specify the size of the original document.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Sides
O*
Short Edge
Long Edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides
of the document.
Content Type
Te xt*
Te xt/ Ph ot o
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the source of the original document.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Behind a PABX
On
O*
Set the printer to dial a fax number without waiting to recognize the dial tone.
Note: Private Automated Branch Exchange (PABX) is a telephone network that
allows a single access number to
oer
multiple lines to outside callers.
Dial Mode
To ne*
Pulse
Specify the dial mode for incoming or outgoing faxes.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 126
background
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan Red
-4 to 4 (0*)
Magenta Green
-4 to 4 (0*)
Ye l l o w Blue
-4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the color intensity during scanning.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold
(128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout setting for
that color.
Contrast
Best for Content*
0
1
2
3
4
5
Set the contrast of the output.
Background Removal
Level
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the amount of background visible on a scanned image.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image.
Scan Edge to Edge
On
O*
Allow edgetoedge scanning of the original document.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness of the scanned image.
Temp eratur e
4 to 4 (0*)
Specify whether to generate a cooler or warmer output.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 127
background
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Automatic Redial
0–9 (5*)
Specify the number of attempts that the printer redials before it cancels sending
the fax to a specified destination.
Redial Frequency
1–200 minutes (3*)
Increase the time between redial attempts to increase the chance of sending
fax successfully.
Enable ECM
On*
O
Activate Error Correction Mode (ECM) for fax jobs.
Note: ECM detects and corrects errors in the fax transmission process caused
by telephone line noise and poor signal strength.
Enable Fax Scans
On*
O
Create faxes using the printer scanner.
Driver to Fax
On*
O
Allow the print driver to send fax.
Allow Save as Shortcut
On*
O
Save fax numbers as shortcuts on the printer.
Max Speed
33600*
14400
9600
4800
2400
Set the maximum speed for sending fax.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Turn on scanning of custom jobs by default.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a preview of the scan on the display.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Adjust ADF Skew
O
On*
Correct slight skew in the scanned image.
Enable Color Fax Scans
O
by Default*
On by Default
Never Use
Always Use
Enable color scans for fax.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 128
background
Menu item Description
Auto Convert Color Faxes to
Mono Faxes
On*
O
Convert all outgoing color faxes to black and white.
Confirm Fax Number
O*
On
Ask the user to confirm the fax number.
Dial Prefix Set a dialing prefix.
Dialing Prefix Rules Establish a dialing prefix rule.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Receive Settings
Menu item Description
Fax Job Waiting
None*
To ne r
Toner and Supplies
Remove fax jobs that request specific unavailable resources from the print
queue.
Rings to Answer
1–25 (3*)
Set the number of rings required before the printer answers the incoming
calls.
Auto Reduction
On*
O
Scale incoming fax to fit on the page.
Paper Source
Tray [X]
Auto*
Set the paper source for printing incoming fax.
Sides
On
O*
Print on both sides of the paper.
Separator Sheets
None*
Before Job
After Job
Specify whether to insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [X] (1*)
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Output Bin
Standard Bin
Specify the output bin for received faxes.
Fax Footer
On
O*
Print the transmission information at the bottom of each page from a received
fax.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 129
background
Menu item Description
Fax Footer Time Stamp
Receive*
Print
Print the time stamp at the bottom of each page from a received fax.
Holding Faxes
Held Fax Mode
O*
Always On
Manual
Scheduled
Hold received faxes from printing until they are released.
Holding Faxes
Fax Holding Schedule
Assign a schedule for holding faxes.
Note: This menu item appears only if Held Fax Mode is set to Scheduled.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Enable Fax Receive
On*
O
Set the printer to receive fax.
Enable Color Fax Receive
On*
O
Set the printer to receive fax in color.
Enable Caller ID
On
O*
Show the caller ID information of the incoming call on the printer display.
Block No Name Fax
On
O*
Block incoming faxes without fax IDs.
Banned Fax List
Add Banned Fax
Specify the phone numbers that you want to block.
Answer On
All Rings*
Single Ring Only
Double Ring Only
Triple Ring Only
Single or Double Rings Only
Single or Triple Rings Only
Double or Triple Rings Only
Set a distinctive ring pattern for incoming fax.
Auto Answer
On*
O
Set the printer to receive fax automatically.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 130
background
Menu item Description
Manual Answer Code
0–9 (9*)
Manually enter a code on the telephone number pad to begin receiving fax.
Notes:
This menu item appears only when the printer shares a line with a
telephone.
This menu item appears only when you set the printer to receive fax
manually.
Fax Forwarding
Print*
Print and Forward
Forward
Specify whether to forward received fax.
Forward To
Destination 1
Destination 2
Specify where to forward received fax.
Note: This menu item appears only when Fax Forwarding is set to Print and
Forward or Forward.
Max Speed
33600*
14400
9600
4800
2400
Set the maximum speed for transmitting fax.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 131
background
Fax Cover Page
Menu item Description
Fax Cover Page
O by Default*
On by Default
Never Use
Always Use
Configure the settings for the fax cover page.
Include To field
O*
On
Include From field
O*
On
From
Include Message Field
O*
On
Message:
Include Logo
O*
On
Include Footer [x]
O*
On
Footer [x]
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Log Settings
Menu item Description
Transmission Log Frequency
Always*
Never
Only for Error
Specify how often the printer creates a transmission log.
Transmission Log Action
Print
O
On*
Email
O*
On
Print or email a log for successful fax transmission or transmission error.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 132
background
Menu item Description
Receive Error Log
Print Never*
Print on Error
Print a log for faxreceive failures.
Auto Print Logs
On*
O
Print all fax activity.
Log Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Specify the paper source for printing logs.
Logs Display
Remote Fax Name*
Dialed Number
Identify the sender by remote fax name or fax number.
Enable Job Log
On*
O
View a summary of all fax jobs.
Enable Call Log
On*
O
View a summary of the fax call history.
Log Output Bin
Standard Bin*
Bin [x]
Specify the output bin for printed logs.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Speaker Settings
Menu item Description
Speaker Mode
Always
O*
Always On
On until Connected
Set the fax speaker mode.
Speaker Volume
Low*
High
Adjust the fax speaker volume.
Ringer Volume
O*
On
Enable the ringer volume.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 133
background
VoIP Settings
Menu item Description
VoIP Protocol
SIP*
H.323
Set the Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) protocol.
STUN Server Specify the STUN server to traverse a firewall.
Force Fax Mode
O
On*
Switch VoIP gateway from analog to T.38 at the beginning of a fax call.
Force Fax Mode Delay
0–15 (7*)
Set the time delay in seconds when sending another invite of Force Fax Mode.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
SIP Settings
Menu item Description
Proxy Specify the IP address of the system that converts the phone number to an IP
address where the fax is sent.
Registrar Specify a name or IP address of the system that handles the registration of
Session Initiation Protocol (SIP) clients.
User Specify the name of the user for SIP.
Password Specify the password that is used in registering with the SIP Registrar.
Auth ID The user name that is used when registering.
Note: If the Auth ID setting is not set, the setting uses the user name of the
User field instead.
Transport For Registration
UDP*
TCP
Set the SIP transport type for registration.
Transport For Incoming Calls
UDP*
TCP
UDP And TCP
Set the SIP transport type for incoming calls.
Transport For Outgoing Calls
UDP*
TCP
Set the SIP transport type for outgoing calls.
Outbound Proxy Specify an outbound proxy to forward all SIP communication.
Contact Specify a contact name for SIP.
Realm Specify a realm name for SIP.
Note: If the Realm setting is not set, the setting uses the name of the Contact
instead.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 134
background
Menu item Description
SIP Registration Status Show the status of the SIP Registration.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
H.323 Settings
Menu item Description
Gateway Specify the H.323 gateway IP address.
Gatekeeper Specify the H.323 gatekeeper.
User Specify the user name used with the H.323 gateway.
Password Specify the password for the H.323 gateway.
Enable Fast Start
O*
On
Enable Fast Start.
Disable H.245 Tunneling
O*
On
Disable H.323 Tunneling.
Disable Gatekeeper Discovery
O
On*
Disable H.323 Gatekeeper Discovery.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
T.38 Setti ngs
Menu item Description
Indicator Redundancy
0–5 (3*)
Set the number of times that a fax indicator is repeated in the T.38
communication.
Low Speed Redundancy
0–5 (3*)
Set the number of times that low speed data is repeated in the T.38
communication.
High Speed Redundancy
0–5 (1*)
Set the number of times that high-speed data is repeated in the T.38
communication.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Server Setup
General Fax Settings
Menu item Description
To Format Specify a fax recipient.
Note: If you want to use the fax number, then type the number sign (#) before
a number.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 135
background
Menu item Description
Reply Address Specify a reply address for sending fax.
Subject Specify the fax subject and message.
Message
Enable analog receive
O*
On
Set the printer to receive analog faxes.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Server Email Settings
Menu item Description
Use Email SMTP Server
On
O*
Use the Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) settings for email in receiving
and sending faxes.
Note: When set to On, all other settings of the Fax Server Email Settings
menu are not shown.
Primary SMTP Gateway Type the IP address or host name of the primary SMTP server.
Primary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the port number of the primary SMTP server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Type the server IP address or host name of your secondary or backup SMTP
server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the server port number of your secondary or backup SMTP server.
SMTP Timeout
5–30 (30*)
Set the time before the printer times out if the SMTP server does not respond.
Reply Address Specify a reply address for sending fax.
Use SSL/TLS
Disabled*
Negotiate
Required
Specify whether to send fax using an encrypted link.
Require Trusted Certificate
O
On*
Specify a trusted certificate when accessing the SMTP server.
SMTP Server Authentication
No authentication required*
Login / Plain
NTLM
CRAMMD5
DigestMD5
Kerberos 5
Set the authentication type for the SMTP server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 136
background
Menu item Description
DeviceInitiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Specify whether credentials are required for deviceinitiated email.
User
Initiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Use Session User ID and
Password
Use Session Email address
and Password
Prompt user
Specify whether credentials are required for userinitiated email.
Use Active Directory Device
Credentials
O*
On
Enable user credentials and group destinations to connect to the SMTP server.
Device Userid Specify the user ID and password to connect to the SMTP server.
Device Password
Kerberos 5 REALM Specify the realm for the Kerberos 5 authentication protocol.
NTLM Domain Specify the domain name for the NTLM security protocol.
Disable "SMTP server not set
up" error
O*
On
Hide the “SMTP server not set up” error message.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Fax Server Scan Settings
Menu item Description
Image Format
TIFF (.tif)
PDF (.pdf)*
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format for the scanned image.
Content Type
Te xt*
Te xt/ Ph ot o
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content of the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 137
background
Menu item Description
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the source of the original document.
Fax Resolution
Standard*
Fine
Super Fine
Ultra Fine
Set the fax resolution.
Sides
O*
Short Edge
Long Edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides
of the document.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Set the darkness of the output.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.
Original Size
[List of paper sizes]
Set the paper size of the original document.
Notes:
Mixed Sizes is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international
factory default setting.
This setting may vary depending on your printer model.
Use Multi
Page TIFF
O
On*
Choose between single and multiplepage TIFF files.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 138
background
E-mail
E
mail Setup
Menu item Description
Primary SMTP Gateway Type the IP address or host name of the primary SMTP server for
sending e-mail.
Primary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the port number of the primary SMTP server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Type the server IP address or host name of your secondary or
backup SMTP server.
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port
1–65535 (25*)
Enter the server port number of your secondary or backup SMTP
server.
SMTP Timeout
5–30 seconds (30*)
Set the time before the printer times out if the SMTP server does
not respond.
Reply Address Specify a reply address in the email.
Always use SMTP default Reply Address
On
O*
Always use the default reply address in the SMTP server.
Use SSL/TLS
Disabled*
Negotiate
Required
Specify whether to send email using an encrypted link.
Require Trusted Certificate
O
On*
Require a trusted certificate when accessing the SMTP server.
SMTP Server Authentication
No authentication required*
Login / Plain
NTLM
CRAMMD5
DigestMD5
Kerberos 5
Set the authentication type for the SMTP server.
Device
Initiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Specify whether credentials are required for deviceinitiated email.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 139
background
Menu item Description
UserInitiated Email
None*
Use Device SMTP Credentials
Use Session User ID and Password
Use Session Email address and Password
Prompt user
Specify whether credentials are required for userinitiated email.
Use Active Directory Device Credentials
O*
On
Specify whether credentials are required for userinitiated email.
Device Userid Specify the user ID and password to connect to the SMTP server.
Device Password
Kerberos 5 REALM Specify the realm for the Kerberos 5 authentication protocol.
NTLM Domain Specify the domain name for the NTLM security protocol.
Disable “SMTP server not set up” error
O*
On
Hide the “SMTP server not set up” error message.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Email Defaults
Menu item Description
Subject: Specify the email subject and message.
Message:
File Name Specify the filename for the scanned document.
Format
JPEG (.jpg)
PDF (.pdf)*
TIFF (.tif)
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format of the scanned document.
Global OCR Settings
Recognized Languages
Auto Rotate
(O*)
Despeckle (O*)
Auto Contrast Enhance
(O*)
Configure the settings for optical character recognition (OCR).
Note: This menu item appears only if you have purchased and installed an OCR
solution.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 140
background
Menu item Description
PDF Settings
PDF Version (1.5*)
Archival Version (A1a*)
Highly Compressed (O*)
Secure (O*)
Searchable
(O*)
Archival (PDF/A) (O*)
Configure the PDF settings of the scanned document.
Notes:
Archival Version and Archival (PDF/A) are supported only when PDF
Version is set to 1.4.
Highly Compressed appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt/ Ph ot o *
Photo
Graphics
Improve the output result based on the content type of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the content source of the original document.
Color
Black and White
Gray
Color*
Auto
Set the printer to capture file content in color or in mono.
Resolution
75 dpi
150 dpi*
200 dpi
300 dpi
400 dpi
600 dpi
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Original Size
Mixed Sizes*
Set the paper size of the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 141
background
Menu item Description
Sides
O*
Short Edge
Long Edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides of
the document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye ll o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
Email Bit Depth (1 bit*)
Minimum Scan Resolution (300 dpi*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
JPEG Quality
Best for content*
5–95
Set the JPEG quality of the scanned image.
Contrast
Best for content*
0–5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document.
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 142
background
Menu item Description
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the scanned image.
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Scan the original document from edge to edge.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness in the scanned image.
Temp eratur e
4 to 4 (0*)
Generate a bluer or redder output of the original document.
Blank Pages
Blank Page Removal (Do Not Remove*)
Blank Page Sensitivity (5*)
Set the sensitivity of scans in relation to blank pages in the original
document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Max Email Size
0–65535 (0*)
Set the allowable file size for each email.
Size Error Message Specify an error message that the printer sends when an email exceeds
its allowable file size.
Note: You can type up to 1024 characters.
Limit Destinations Limit sending of email only to the specified list of domain name.
Note: Use a comma to separate each domain.
Send Me a Copy
Never appears*
On by Default
O by Default
Always On
Send a copy of the email to yourself.
Allow self e
mails only
O*
On
Set the printer to send emails to yourself only.
Use cc:/bcc:
O*
On
Enable carbon copy and blind carbon copy in email.
Use Multi
Page TIFF
O
On*
Enable scanning of multiple TIFF images in one TIFF file.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 143
background
Menu item Description
TIFF Compression
JPEG
LZW*
Specify the compression type for TIFF files.
Text Defau lt
5–95 (75*)
Set the text quality in the content being scanned.
Text/Photo Default
5–95 (75*)
Set the text and photo quality in the content being scanned.
Photo Default
5–95 (50*)
Set the photo quality of the content being scanned.
Adjust ADF Skew
O
On*
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are
scanned from the ADF.
Transmission Log
Print log*
Do Not Print Log
Print Only For Error
Print a transmission log for email scans.
Log Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for printing email logs.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the
specified settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent
settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a scan preview of the original document.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Allow Save as Shortcut
O
On*
Save an email address as a shortcut.
E
mail Images Sent As
Attachment*
Web Link
Specify how to send the images that are included in the email.
Reset E-mail Information After Sending
O
On*
Reset the To, Subject, Message, and Filename fields to their default
values after sending an email.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 144
background
Web Link Setup
Menu item Description
Server Specify the credentials of the server that is hosting the images that are included
in the e-mail.
Login
Password
Path
File Name
Web Link
FTP
FTP Defaults
Menu item Description
Format
JPEG (.jpg)
PDF (.pdf)*
TIFF (.tif)
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format for the scanned image.
Global OCR Settings
Recognized Languages
Auto Rotate (O*)
Despeckle (O*)
Auto Contrast Enhance (O*)
Configure the settings for optical character recognition (OCR).
Note: This menu item appears only if you have purchased and installed an OCR
solution.
PDF Settings
PDF Version (1.5*)
Archival Version (A1a*)
Highly Compressed (O*)
Secure
(O*)
Searchable (O*)
Archival (PDF/A) (O*)
Configure the PDF settings for the scanned image.
Notes:
Archival Version and Archival (PDF/A) are supported only when PDF
Version is set to 1.4.
Highly Compressed appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 145
background
Menu item Description
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt/ Ph ot o *
Graphics
Photo
Improve the output result based on the content type of the original document.
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the content source of the original document.
Color
Black and White
Gray
Color*
Auto
Set the printer to capture file content in color or in mono.
Resolution
75 dpi
150 dpi*
200 dpi
300 dpi
400 dpi
600 dpi
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Original Size
Mixed Sizes*
Set the paper size of the original document.
Sides
O*
Long Edge
Short Edge
Specify the orientation when scanning on both sides of the document.
File Name Specify the file name of the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 146
background
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye ll o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
FTP Bit Depth (1 bit*)
Minimum Scan Resolution (300 dpi*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
JPEG Quality
Best for content*
5–95
Set the JPEG quality of the scanned image.
Contrast
Best for content*
0
1
2
3
4
5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document .
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 147
background
Menu item Description
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Allow edgetoedge scanning of the original document.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness in the scanned image.
Temp eratur e
4 to 4 (0*)
Generate a bluer or redder output of the original document.
Blank Pages
Blank Page Removal (Do Not Remove*)
Blank Page Sensitivity (5*)
Set the sensitivity of scans in relation to blank pages in the original
document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Text Defau lt
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text on the scanned image.
Text/Photo Default
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text and photo on the scanned image.
Photo Default
5–95 (50*)
Set the quality of photo on the scanned image.
Use MultiPage TIFF
On*
O
Enable scanning of multiple TIFF images in one TIFF file.
TIFF Compression
LZW*
JPEG
Specify the compression type for TIFF files.
Transmission Log
Print Log*
Do Not Print Log
Print Only For Error
Print a transmission log for FTP scans.
Log Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for printing FTP logs.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the specified
settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a preview of the original document.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 148
background
Menu item Description
Allow Save as Shortcut
O
On*
Save an FTP address as a shortcut.
Adjust ADF Skew
O*
On
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are scanned
from the ADF.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
USB Drive
Flash Drive Scan
Menu item Description
Format
JPEG (.jpg)
PDF (.pdf)*
TIFF (.tif)
XPS (.xps)
TXT (.txt)
RTF (.rtf)
DOCX (.docx)
XLSX (.xlsx)
CSV (.csv)
Specify the file format for the scanned image.
Global OCR Settings
Recognized Languages
Auto Rotate (O*)
Despeckle (O*)
Auto Contrast Enhance (O*)
Configure the settings for optical character recognition (OCR).
Note: This menu item appears only if you have purchased and installed an OCR
solution.
PDF Settings
PDF Version (1.5*)
Archival Version (A1a*)
Highly Compressed (O*)
Secure
(O*)
Searchable
(O*)
Archival (PDF/A) (O*)
Configure the PDF settings of the scanned image.
Notes:
Archival Version and Archival (PDF/A) are supported only when PDF
Version is set to 1.4.
Highly Compressed appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage
drive (ISD) is installed.
Content Type
Te xt
Te xt/ Ph ot o *
Graphics
Photo
Improve the output result based on the content type of the original document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 149
background
Menu item Description
Content Source
Black and White Laser
Color Laser*
Inkjet
Photo/Film
Magazine
Newspaper
Press
Other
Improve the output result based on the content source of the original document.
Color
Black and White
Gray
Color*
Auto
Set the printer to capture file content in color or in mono.
Resolution
75 dpi
150 dpi*
200 dpi
300 dpi
400 dpi
600 dpi
Set the resolution of the scanned image.
Darkness
1–9 (5*)
Adjust the darkness of the scanned image.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
Specify the orientation of the original document.
Original Size
Mixed Sizes*
Set the paper size of the original document.
Sides
O*
Long edge
Short edge
Specify the orientation of the original document when scanning on both sides of
the document.
File Name Specify the file name of the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 150
background
Advanced Imaging
Menu item Description
Color Balance
Cyan (0*)
Magenta (0*)
Ye ll o w ( 0 * )
Adjust the color intensity for cyan, magenta, and yellow.
Color Dropout
Color Dropout (None*)
Default Red Threshold (128*)
Default Green Threshold (128*)
Default Blue Threshold (128*)
Specify which color to drop during scanning, and adjust the dropout
setting for that color.
Auto Color Detect
Color Sensitivity (5*)
Area Sensitivity (5*)
Scan Bit Depth (1 bit*)
Minimum Scan Resolution (300 dpi*)
Configure the auto color detection setting.
JPEG Quality
Best for content*
5–95
Set the JPEG quality of the scanned image.
Contrast
Best for content*
0–5
Specify the contrast for the scanned image.
Background Removal
Background Detection (Contentbased*)
Level (0*)
Remove the background color or image noise from the original
document.
Notes:
Content-based removes the background color from the original
document.
Fixed removes image noise from a photo.
Mirror Image
O*
On
Create a mirror image of the original document.
Negative Image
O*
On
Create a negative image of the original document.
Shadow Detail
4 to 4 (0*)
Adjust the shadow detail in the scanned image.
Scan Edge to Edge
O*
On
Scan the original document from edge to edge.
Sharpness
1–5 (3*)
Adjust the sharpness in the scanned image.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 151
background
Menu item Description
Temp eratur e
4 to 4 (0*)
Generate a bluer or redder output of the original document.
Blank Pages
Blank Page Removal (Do Not Remove*)
Blank Page Sensitivity (5*)
Set the sensitivity of scans in relation to blank pages in the original
document.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Admin Controls
Menu item Description
Text Defau lt
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text on the scanned image.
Text/Photo Default
5–95 (75*)
Set the quality of text and photo on the scanned image.
Photo Default
5–95 (50*)
Set the quality of a photo on the scanned image.
Use Multi
Page TIFF
O
On*
Enable scanning of multiple TIFF images in one TIFF file.
TIFF Compression
LZW*
JPEG
Specify the compression type for TIFF files.
Custom Job Scanning
O*
On
Set the printer to scan the first set of original documents using the specified
settings, and then scan the next set with the same or dierent settings.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Scan Preview
O*
On
Show a scan preview of the original document.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Adjust ADF Skew
O*
On
Set the printer to adjust the skewed images from documents that are scanned
from the ADF.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Flash Drive Print
Menu item Description
Number of Copies
1–9999 (1*)
Set the number of copies.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 152
background
Menu item Description
Paper Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Manual Paper
Manual Envelope
Set the paper source for the print job.
Color
O
On*
Print a flash drive file in color.
Collate
(1,1,1) (2,2,2)
(1,2,3) (1,2,3)*
Keep the pages of a print job stacked in sequence, particularly when printing multiple
copies of the job.
Sides
1Sided*
2Sided
Specify whether to print on one side or both sides of the paper.
Flip Style
Long Edge*
Short Edge
Determine which side of the paper is bound when performing twosided printing.
Pages per Side
O*
2 pages per side
3 pages per side
4 pages per side
6 pages per side
9 pages per side
12 pages per side
16 pages per side
Print multiple page images on one side of a sheet of paper.
Pages per Side Ordering
Horizontal*
Reverse Horizontal
Reverse Vertical
Vertical
Specify the positioning of multiple page images when using Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Orientation
Auto*
Landscape
Portrait
Specify the orientation of multiple page images when using Pages per Side menu.
Pages per Side Border
None*
Solid
Print a border around each page image when using Pages per Side menu.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 153
background
Menu item Description
Separator Sheets
O*
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
Insert blank separator sheets when printing.
Separator Sheet Source
Tray [x] (1*)
Multipurpose Feeder
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.
Blank Pages
Do Not Print*
Print
Print blank pages in a print job.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Network/Ports
Network Overview
Menu item Description
Active Adapter
Auto*
Standard Network
Wireless
Specify the type of the network connection.
Note: Wireless is available only in printers connected to a wireless network.
Network Status Show the connectivity status of the printer network.
Display Network Status on
Printer
O
On*
Show the network status on the display.
Speed, Duplex Show the speed of the currently active network card.
IPv4 Show the IPv4 address.
All IPv6 Addresses Show all IPv6 addresses.
Reset Print Server Reset all active network connections to the printer.
Note: This setting removes all network
configuration
settings.
Network Job Timeout
O
On* (90 seconds)
Set the time before the printer cancels a network print job.
Banner Page
O*
On
Print a banner page.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 154
background
Menu item Description
Scan to PC Port Range Specify a valid port range for printers that are behind a port blocking firewall.
Enable Network Connections
O
On*
Enable the printer to connect to a network.
Enable LLDP
O*
On
Enable Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) in the printer.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Wireless
Note: This menu is available only in printers connected to a WiFi network or printers that have a wireless
network adapter.
Menu item Description
Setup Using Mobile App Configure the WiFi connection using Lexmark Mobile Assistant.
Setup On Printer Panel
Choose Network
Add WiFi Network
Network Name
Network Mode
Infrastructure
Wireless Security Mode
Disabled*
WEP
WPA2/WPA - Personal
WPA2 - Personal
Configure the WiFi connection using the control panel.
WiFi Protected Setup
WPS Auto Detect
O
On*
Start Push Button Method
Start PIN Method
Establish a WiFi network and enable network security.
Notes:
WPS Auto Detect appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to WEP.
Start Push-Button Method connects the printer to a WiFi
network when buttons on both the printer and the access point
(wireless router) are pressed within a given time.
Start PIN Method connects the printer to a WiFi network when
a PIN on the printer is entered into the wireless settings of the
access point.
Network Mode
BSS Type
Infrastructure*
Specify the network mode.
Use printer menus 155
background
Menu item Description
Compatibility
802.11b/g/n (2.4GHz)*
802.11a/b/g/n/ac (2.4GHz/5GHz)
802.11a/n/ac (5GHz)
Specify the standard for the WiFi network.
Note: 802.11a/b/g/n/ac (2.4GHz/5GHz) and 802.11a/n/ac (5GHz) only
appear when a WiFi option is installed.
Wireless Security Mode
Disabled*
WEP
WPA2/WPA-Personal
WPA2-Personal
802.1x - RADIUS
Set the security mode for connecting the printer to WiFi devices.
WEP Authentication Mode
Auto*
Open
Shared
Set the type of Wireless Encryption Protocol (WEP) for the printer.
Note: This menu item appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to WEP.
Set WEP Key Specify a WEP password for secure WiFi connection.
WPA2/WPA Personal
AES
Enable WiFi security through Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA).
Note: This menu item appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to WPA2/WPA-Personal.
Set Pre
Shared Key Set the password for secure WiFi connection.
WPA2-Personal
AES
Enable WiFi security through WPA2.
Note: This menu item appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to WPA2-Personal.
802.1x Encryption Mode
WPA+
WPA2*
Enable WiFi security through 802.1x standard.
Note: This menu item appears only when the Wireless Security
Mode is set to 802.1x - RADIUS.
IPv4
Enable DHCP
On*
O
Set Static IP Address
IP Address
Netmask
Gateway
Enable and configure IPv4 settings in the printer.
Use printer menus 156
background
Menu item Description
IPv6
Enable IPv6
On*
O
Enable DHCPv6
On
O*
Stateless Address
Autoconfiguration
On*
O
DNS Server Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Router
Address
Prefix
All IPv6 Addresses
All IPv6 Router Addresses
Enable and configure IPv6 settings in the printer.
Network Address
UAA
LAA
View the network addresses.
PCL SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch automatically to PCL emulation when a print
job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: If PCL SmartSwitch is
o,
then the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
PS SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch automatically to PS emulation when a print
job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: If PS SmartSwitch is o, then the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
Job Buering
On
O*
Temporarily store print jobs in the hard disk or intelligent storage
drive (ISD) before printing.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Mac Binary PS
Auto*
On
O
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.
O
filters
print jobs using the standard protocol.
WiFi Direct
Note: This menu is available only in printers connected to a WiFi network or printers that have a wireless
network adapter.
Use printer menus 157
background
Menu item Description
Enable WiFi Direct
On
O*
Set the printer to connect directly to Wi-Fi devices.
Wi
Fi Direct Name Specify the name of the WiFi Direct network.
WiFi Direct Password Set the password to authenticate and validate users on a WiFi connection.
Show Password on Setup Page
O
On*
Show the WiFi Direct Password on the Network Setup Page.
Preferred Channel Number
1–11
Auto*
Set the preferred channel of the WiFi network.
Group Owner IP Address Specify the IP address of the group owner.
Auto
Accept Push Button
Requests
O*
On
Accept requests to connect to the network automatically.
Note: Accepting clients automatically is not secured.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
AirPrint
Note: This menu appears only in the Embedded Web Server.
Menu item Description
All AirPrint Functions Show the AirPrint status of the printer.
Enable AirPrint
On*
O
Enable the AirPrint feature.
Note: This menu item appears only if Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) or mDNS
is disabled.
Enable iBeacon
On
O*
Enable the iBeacon feature.
Bonjour Name Identify printer designation and location.
Organization Name
Organizational Unit
Printer Location
Printer's Latitude
Printer's Longitude
Printer's Altitude
More Options
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 158
background
Mobile Services Management
Menu item Description
Enable IPP Print
On*
O
Allow printing from mobile devices using Internet Printing Protocol (IPP).
Enable IPP Fax
On*
O
Allow sending faxes using Internet Printing Protocol (IPP).
Enable IPP Over USB
On*
O
Allow print or scan jobs using USB connection.
Enable Scan
On*
O
Allow scanning using eSCL protocol.
Enable Mopria Discovery
On*
O
Allow the printer to be detected by Mopriaenabled devices.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Ethernet
Menu item Description
Network Speed Show the speed of the active network adapter.
IPv4
Enable DHCP (On*)
Set Static IP Address
Configure the IPv4 settings.
IPv6
Enable IPv6 (On*)
Enable DHCPv6 (O*)
Stateless Address Autoconfiguration
(On*)
DNS Server Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Address
Manually Assigned IPv6 Router
Address
Prefix
(64*)
All IPv6 Addresses
All IPv6 Router Addresses
Configure the IPv6 settings.
Network Address
UAA
LAA
Specify the network address.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 159
background
Menu item Description
PCL SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch automatically to PCL emulation when a print
job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
PS SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch automatically to PostScript emulation when
a print job requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine
incoming data and uses the default printer language specified in
the Setup menu.
Job Buering
O*
On
Temporarily store print jobs in the hard disk or intelligent storage
drive (ISD) before printing.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is
installed.
Mac Binary PS
Auto*
On
O
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
Auto processes print jobs from computers using either
Windows or Macintosh operating systems.
O filters PostScript print jobs using the standard protocol.
Energy Ecient Ethernet
On
O
Auto*
Reduce power consumption when the printer does not receive data
from the Ethernet network.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
TCP/IP
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
Set Hostname Set the current TCP/IP host name.
Domain Name Set the domain name.
Allow DHCP/BOOTP to update
NTP server
On*
O
Allow the DHCP and BOOTP clients to update the NTP settings of the printer.
Zero Configuration Name Specify a service name for the zero configuration network.
Enable Auto IP
O
On*
Assign an IP address automatically.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 160
background
Menu item Description
DNS Server Address Specify the current Domain Name System (DNS) server address.
Backup DNS Address Specify the backup DNS server addresses.
Backup DNS Address 2
Backup DNS Address 3
Domain Search Order Specify a list of domain names to locate the printer and its resources that reside
in dierent domains on the network.
Enable DDNS
O*
On
Update the Dynamic DNS settings.
DDNS TTL Specify the current DDNS settings.
Default TTL
DDNS Refresh Time
Enable mDNS
O
On*
Update the multicast DNS settings.
WINS Server Address Specify a server address for Windows Internet Name Service (WINS).
Enable BOOTP
O*
On
Allow the BOOTP to assign a printer IP address.
Restricted Server List Specify the IP addresses that are allowed to communicate with the printer over
TCP/IP.
Notes:
Use a comma to separate each IP address.
You can add up to 50 IP addresses.
Restricted Server List Options
Block All Ports*
Block Printing Only
Block Printing and HTTP Only
Specify the access option for IP addresses that are not in the list.
MTU
256–1500 Ethernet (1500*)
Specify a maximum transmission unit (MTU) parameter for the TCP connections.
Raw Print Port
1–65535 (9100*)
Specify a raw port number for printers connected on a network.
Outbound Trac Maximum
Speed
O*
On
Set the maximum transfer rate of the printer.
Note: When enabled, the option for this setting is 100–1000000
Kilobits/second.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 161
background
Menu item Description
TLS Support
Enable TLSv1.0 (O)
Enable TLSv1.1
(O*)
Enable TLSv1.2 (On*)
Enable the Transport Layer Security protocol.
SSL Cipher List Specify the cipher algorithms to use for the SSL or the TLS connections.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
SNMP
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
SNMP Versions 1 and 2c
Enabled
O
On*
Allow SNMP Set
O
On*
Enable PPM MIB
O
On*
SNMP Community
Configure Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) versions 1
and 2c to install print drivers and applications.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 162
background
Menu item Description
SNMP Version 3
Enabled
O
On*
Context Name
Set Read/Write Credentials
User Name
Authentication Password
Privacy Password
Set Readonly Credentials
User Name
Authentication Password
Privacy Password
Authentication Hash
MD5
SHA1*
Minimum Authentication Level
No Authentication, No Privacy
Authentication, No Privacy
Authentication, Privacy*
Privacy Algorithm
DES
AES128*
Configure SNMP version 3 to install and update the printer security.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
IPSec
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
Enable IPSec
O*
On
Enable Internet Protocol Security (IPSec).
Base Configuration
Default*
Compatibility
Secure
Set the IPSec base configuration.
Note: This menu item appears only when Enable IPSec is set to
On.
DH (Die
Hellman) Group Proposal
modp2048 (14)*
modp3072 (15)
modp4096 (16)
modp6144 (17)
Set the IPSec base configuration.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base
Configuration
is set
to Compatibility.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 163
background
Menu item Description
Proposed Encryption Method
3DES
AES*
Set the encryption method.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base
Configuration
is set
to Compatibility.
Proposed Authentication Method
SHA1
SHA256*
SHA512
Set the authentication method.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base Configuration is set
to Compatibility.
IKE SA Lifetime (Hours)
1
2
4
8
24*
Specify the IKE SA expiry period.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base Configuration is set
to Secure.
IPSec SA Lifetime (Hours)
1
2
4
8*
24
Specify the IPSec SA expiry period.
Note: This menu item appears only when Base
Configuration
is set
to Secure.
IPSec Device Certificate Specify an IPSec certificate.
Note: This menu item appears only when Enable IPSec is set to
On.
Pre
Shared Key Authenticated
Connections
Host [x]
Configure the authenticated connections of the printer.
Note: These menu items appear only when Enable IPSec is set to
On.
Certificate Authenticated Connections
Host [x] Address[/subnet]
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
802.1x
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
Active
O*
On
Let the printer join networks that require authentication before
allowing access.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 164
background
Menu item Description
802.1x Authentication
Device Login Name
Device Login Password
Validate Serve Certificate (On*)
Enable Event Logging (O*)
802.1x Device
Certificate
Configure the settings for authenticating the 802.1x connection.
Allowable Authentication Mechanisms
EAP MD5 (On*)
EAP - MSCHAPv2 (On*)
LEAP (On*)
PEAP (On*)
EAP - TLS (On*)
EAP - TTLS (On*)
TTLS Authentication Method
(MSCHAPv2*)
Configure the allowed authentication mechanisms for the 802.1x
connection.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
LPD Configuration
Note: This menu appears only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.
Menu item Description
LPD Timeout
0–65535 seconds (90*)
Set the timeout value to stop the Line Printer Daemon (LPD) server
from waiting indefinitely for hung or invalid print jobs.
LPD Banner Page
O*
On
Print a banner page for all LPD print jobs.
Note: A banner page is the first page of a print job used as a
separator of print jobs and to identify the originator of the print job
request.
LPD Trailer Page
O*
On
Print a trailer page for all LPD print jobs.
Note: A trailer page is the last page of a print job.
LPD Carriage Return Conversion
O*
On
Enable carriage return conversion.
Note: Carriage return is a mechanism that commands the printer to
move the position of the cursor to the first position on the same
line.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 165
background
HTTP/FTP Settings
Menu item Description
Proxy
HTPP Proxy IP Address
HTTP Default IP Port
FTP Proxy IP Address
FTP Default IP Port
Authentication
User Name
Password
Local Domains
Configure the HTTP and FTP server settings.
Other Settings
Enable HTTP Server (On*)
Access the Embedded Web Server to monitor and manage the printer.
Other Settings
Enable HTPPS (On*)
Enable Hypertext Transfer Protocol Secure (HTTPS) to encrypt data
transferring to and from the print server.
Other Settings
Force HTTPS Connections (O*)
Force the printer to use HTTPS connections.
Other Settings
Enable FTP/TFTP (On*)
Send files using FTP/TFTP.
Other Settings
HTTPS Device
Certificate
(default*)
View the HTTP device certificate used on the printer.
Other Settings
Timeout for HTTP/FTP Requests (30*)
Specify the amount of time before the server connection stops.
Other Settings
Retries for HTTP/FTP Requests (3*)
Set the number of retries to connect to the HTTP/FTP server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
ThinPrint
Menu item Description
Enable ThinPrint
O*
On
Print using ThinPrint.
Port Number
4000–4999 (4000*)
Set the port number for the ThinPrint server.
Bandwidth (bits/sec)
100–1000000 (0*)
Set the speed to transmit data in a ThinPrint environment.
Packet Size (kbytes)
0–64000 (0*)
Set the packet size for data transmission.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 166
background
USB
Menu item Description
PCL SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch to PCL emulation when a print job received through a USB port requires
it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine incoming data and uses the
default printer language specified in the Setup menu.
PS SmartSwitch
O
On*
Set the printer to switch to PostScript emulation when a print job received through a USB port
requires it, regardless of the default printer language.
Note: When this setting is disabled, the printer does not examine incoming data and uses the
default printer language specified in the Setup menu.
Job Buering
O*
On
Temporarily store print jobs in the hard disk or intelligent storage drive (ISD) before printing.
Note: This menu item appears only when a hard disk or an ISD is installed.
Mac Binary PS
Auto*
On
O
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.
Notes:
Auto processes print jobs from computers using either Windows or Macintosh operating
systems.
O
filters
PostScript print jobs using the standard protocol.
Enable USB Port
O
On*
Enable the front USB drive port.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Restrict external network access
Menu item Description
Restrict external network
access
O*
On
Restrict access to network sites.
External network address Specify the network addresses with restricted access.
E
mail address for notification Specify an email address to send a notification of logged events.
Ping frequency
1–300 (10*)
Specify the network query interval in seconds.
Subject Specify the subject and message of the notification email.
Message
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 167
background
Security
Login Methods
Manage Permissions
Menu item Description
Function Access
Access Address Book in Apps
Modify Address Book
Manage Shortcuts
Create Profiles
Manage Bookmarks
Flash Drive Print
Flash Drive Color Printing
Flash Drive Scan
Copy Function
Copy Color Printing
Color Dropout
Email Function
Fax Function
FTP Function
Release Held Faxes
Held Jobs Access
Use Profiles
Cancel Jobs at the Device
Change Language
Internet Printing Protocol (IPP)
Initiate Scans Remotely
B/W Print
Color Print
Network Folder Scan
Hard Disk Print
Hard Disk Color Print
Hard Disk Scan
Control access to the printer functions.
Note: Some menu items appear only when a hard disk or an intelligent
storage drive is installed.
Administrative Menus
Security Menu
Network/Ports Menu
Paper Menu
Reports Menu
Function
Configuration
Menus
Supplies Menu
Option Card Menu
SE Menu
Device Menu
Control access to the printer menu settings.
Use printer menus 168
background
Menu item Description
Device Management
Remote Management
Firmware Updates
Apps Configuration
Operator Panel Lock
Embedded Web Server Access
Import / Export All Settings
Out of Service Erase
Cloud Services Enrollment
Control access to the printer management options.
Apps
New Apps
Slideshow
Change Wallpaper
Screen Saver
Card Copy
Scan Center
Scan Center Custom [x]
Control access to printer applications.
Local Accounts
Menu item Description
Manage Groups/Permissions Show a list of all saved groups in the printer.
Add User
User Name/Password
User Name
Password
PIN
Create local accounts and specify their access to the printer functions,
administrative menus, printer management options, and applications.
Default Login Methods
Note: This menu appears only when you
configure
the settings in the Local Accounts menu.
Menu item Description
Control Panel
User Name/Password
User Name
Password
PIN
Specify the default login method to access the control panel.
Browser
User Name/Password
User Name
Password
PIN
Specify the default login method to access the browser.
Use printer menus 169
background
Schedule USB Devices
Menu item Description
Schedules
Add New Schedule
Schedule access to the front USB port.
Security Audit Log
Menu item Description
Enable Audit
O*
On
Record the events in the secure audit log and remote syslog.
Enable Remote Syslog
O*
On
Send audit logs to a remote server.
Remote Syslog Server Specify the remote syslog server.
Remote Syslog Port
1–65535 (514*)
Specify the remote syslog port.
Remote Syslog Method
Normal UDP*
Stunnel
Specify a syslog method to transmit logged events to a remote server.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 170
background
Menu item Description
Remote Syslog Facility
0 Kernel Messages
1 UserLevel Messages
2 Mail System
3 System Daemons
4 Security/Authorization
Messages*
5 Messages Generated
Internally by Syslogs
6 Line Printer Subsystem
7 Network News Subsystem
8 UUCP Subsystem
9 Clock Daemon
10 Security/Authorization
Messages
11 FTP Daemon
12 NTP Subsystem
13 Log Audit
14 Log Alert
15 Clock Daemon
16 Local Use 0 (local0)
17 Local Use 1 (local1)
18 Local Use 2 (local2)
19 Local Use 3 (local3)
20 Local Use 4 (local4)
21 Local Use 5 (local5)
22 Local Use 6 (local6)
23 Local Use 7 (local7)
Specify a facility code that the printer uses when sending log events to a remote
server.
Severity of Events to Log
0 Emergency
1 Alert
2 Critical
3 Error
4 Warning*
5 Notice
6 Informational
7 Debug
Specify the priority level cuto for logging messages and events.
Remote Syslog Non
Logged
Events
O*
On
Send all events, regardless of severity level, to the remote server.
Admin’s E
mail Address Send email notification of logged events to the administrator.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 171
background
Menu item Description
Email Log Cleared Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when a log entry is deleted.
E
mail Log Wrapped Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when the log becomes full and
begins to overwrite the oldest entries.
Log Full Behavior
Wrap Over Oldest Entries*
Email Log Then Delete All
Entries
Resolve log storage issues when the log fills its allotted memory.
E
mail % Full Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when the log fills its allotted
memory.
% Full Alert Level
1–99 (90*)
E
mail Log Exported Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when a log is exported.
E
mail Log Settings Changed
Alert
O*
On
Send email notification to the administrator when Enable Audit is set.
Log Line Endings
LF (\n)*
CR (\r)
CRLF (\r\n)
Specify how the log file terminates the end of each line.
Digitally Sign Exports
O*
On
Add a digital signature to each exported log file.
Clear Log Delete all audit logs.
Export Log
Syslog (RFC 5424)
Syslog (RFC 3164)
CSV
Export a security log to a flash drive.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 172
background
Login Restrictions
Menu item Description
Login failures
1–10 (3*)
Specify the number of failed login attempts before the user gets locked out.
Failure time frame
1–60 minutes (5*)
Specify the time frame between failed login attempts before the user gets locked out.
Lockout time
1–60 minutes (5*)
Specify the lockout duration.
Web Login Timeout
1–120 minutes (10*)
Specify the delay for a remote login before the user is logged o automatically.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Confidential Print Setup
Menu item Description
Max Invalid PIN
2–10
Set the limit for entering an invalid PIN.
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name are deleted.
Confidential Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set an individual expiration time for each held job before it is automatically deleted
from the hard disk or intelligent storage drive.
Note: A held job is either
Confidential,
Repeat, Reserve, or Verify.
Repeat Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set the expiration time for a print job that you want to repeat.
Verify Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set the expiration time for printing a copy of a job for you to check its quality before
printing the remaining copies.
Reserve Job Expiration
O*
1 Hour
4 Hours
24 Hours
1 Week
Set the expiration time for jobs that you want to store in the printer for printing later.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 173
background
Menu item Description
Require All Jobs to be Held
O*
On
Set the printer to hold all print jobs.
Keep duplicate documents
O*
On
Set the printer to keep all documents with the same file name.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Disk Encryption
Note: This menu appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage drive is installed.
Menu item Description
Status
Enabled
Encryption happens automatically when a storage drive is installed.
Erase Temporary Data Files
Menu item Description
Stored in onboard memory
O*
On
Delete all files stored on the printer memory.
Stored on hard disk
1 Pass Erase*
3 Pass Erase
7 Pass Erase
Delete all files stored on the printer hard disk.
Note: This menu item appears only when a printer hard disk is installed.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Solutions LDAP Settings
Menu item Description
Follow LDAP Referrals
O*
On
Search the dierent servers in the domain for the logged-in user account.
LDAP Certificate Verification
Ye s
No*
Enable verification of LDAP certificates.
Use printer menus 174
background
Miscellaneous
Menu item Description
Protected Features
Show*
Hide
Show all the features that Function Access Control (FAC) protects regardless
of the security permission that the user has.
Note: Hide displays only FACprotected features that the user has access.
Print Permission
O*
On
Let the user log in before printing.
Default Print Permission Login
User Name/Password*
User Name
Set the default login for Print Permission.
Security Reset Jumper
Enable “Guest” access*
No Eect
Specify user access to the printer.
Notes:
Enable “Guest” access provides anyone access to all aspects of the
printer.
No
Eect
may make access to the printer impossible when the required
security information is unavailable.
Use Intelligent Storage Drive for
User Data
O
On*
Enable intelligent storage drive to store user data.
Minimum Password Length
0–32 (0*)
Specify the password length.
Enable Password/PIN Reveal
O*
On
Show the password or personal identification number.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Cloud Services
Cloud Services Enrollment
Menu item Description
View More Information View additional information on the usage of Lexmark Cloud
Services.
Enable communication with Lexmark Cloud
Services
O*
On
Enable the printer to communicate with Lexmark Cloud Services.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 175
background
Menu item Description
View Current Status View the connection status between the printer and Lexmark
Cloud Services.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Reports
Menu Settings Page
Menu item Description
Menu Settings Page Print a report that contains the printer menus.
Device
Menu item Description
Device Information Print a report that contains information about the printer.
Device Statistics Print a report about printer usage and supply status.
Profiles List Print a list of profiles that are stored in the printer.
Asset Report Print a diagnostic tool for print problems.
Note: To avoid clipping the content, print the report on letter or A4size
paper.
Print
Menu item Description
Print Fonts
PCL Fonts
PS Fonts
Print samples and information about the fonts that are available in each printer
language.
Print Demo
Demo Page
Print a page that shows the printer capabilities and supported solutions.
Print Directory Print the resources that are stored in the flash drive, hard disk, or intelligent
storage drive (ISD).
Note: This menu item appears only when a
flash
drive, a hard disk, or an ISD
is installed.
Use printer menus 176
background
Shortcuts
Menu item Description
All Shortcuts Print a report that lists the shortcuts that are stored in the printer.
Note: Fax Shortcuts appears only when fax is installed.
Fax Shortcuts
Copy Shortcuts
E
mail Shortcuts
FTP Shortcuts
Network Folder Shortcuts
Fax
Note: This menu appears only if Fax is
configured,
and Enable Job Log is set to On.
Menu item Description
Fax Job Log Print a report about the last 200 completed fax jobs.
Fax Call Log Print a report about the last 100 attempted, received, and blocked calls.
Network
Menu item Description
Network Setup Page Print a page that shows the configured network and wireless settings on the
printer.
Note: This menu item appears only in network printers or printers connected
to print servers.
Wi
Fi Direct Connected Clients Print a page that shows the list of devices that are connected to the printer using
WiFi Direct.
Note: This menu item appears only when Enable WiFi Direct is set to On.
Troubleshooting
Menu item Description
Print Quality Test Pages Print sample pages to identify and correct print quality defects.
Cleaning the Scanner Print instructions on how to clean the scanner.
Forms Merge
Note: This menu appears only when a hard disk or an intelligent storage drive is installed.
Use printer menus 177
background
Menu item Description
Merge Mode
Print*
Data Capture
Disabled
Specify the mode of operation for Forms Merge.
Data Capture Target
Flash*
Set the target destination where the captured data is forwarded.
Note: This menu item appears only when Merge Mode is set to Data Capture.
Print Port and Filter Settings
Network Port
On*
O
Enable Forms Merge to process all data that are sent to the network port.
Print Port and Filter Settings
Network Filter
Disabled*
NULL
OFIS
OFIS+NULL
OFIS+AS400
AS400
PCL
ZPL
ZPLF
Specify the network filter for all data sent to the printer.
Print Port and Filter Settings
USB Port
On*
O
Enable Forms Merge to process all data that are sent to the USB port.
Print Port and Filter Settings
USB Filter
Disabled*
NULL
OFIS
OFIS+NULL
OFIS+AS400
AS400
PCL
ZPL
ZPLF
Specify the USB filter for all data sent to the printer.
Print Port and Filter Settings
Local Port Timeout
1–100 (10*)
Specify the timeout value for Forms Merge jobs that are sent to the local port.
Miscellaneous
Print All Forms
Print all form sets stored in the intelligent storage drive or hard disk of the printer.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Use printer menus 178
background
Menu item Description
Miscellaneous
Error Page Print
On*
O
Enable printing of an error page when an error is encountered in a Forms Merge job.
Note: An asterisk (*) next to a value indicates the factory default setting.
Printing the Menu Settings Page
From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports > Menu Settings Page.
Use printer menus 179
background
Maintain the printer
Checking the status of parts and supplies
1 From the home screen, touch Status/Supplies.
2 Select the parts or supplies that you want to check.
Note: You can also access this setting by touching the top section of the home screen.
Configuring supply notifications
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Device > Notifications.
3 From the Supplies menu, click Custom Supply Notifications.
4 Select a notification for each supply item.
5 Apply the changes.
Setting up e
mail alerts
Configure the printer to send email alerts when supplies are low, when paper must be changed or added, or
when there is a paper jam.
1 Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the web page correctly.
2 Click Settings > Device > Notifications > E
mail Alert Setup, and then configure the settings.
Note: For more information on SMTP settings, contact your email provider.
3 Apply the changes.
4 Click Setup E-mail Lists and Alerts, and then configure the settings.
5 Apply the changes.
Maintain the printer 180
background
Viewing reports
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Reports.
2 Select the report that you want to view.
Ordering parts and supplies
To order supplies in the U.S., contact Lexmark at 1-800-539-6275 for information about Lexmark authorized
supplies dealers in your area. In other countries or regions, go to
www.lexmark.com or contact the place where
you purchased the printer.
Note: All life estimates for printer supplies assume printing on letter or A4size plain paper.
Warning—Potential Damage: Failure to maintain optimum printer performance, or to replace parts and
supplies, may cause damage to your printer.
Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark parts and supplies. Use of third-party
supplies or parts may aect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging components. It can
also
aect
warranty coverage. Damage caused by the use of third-party parts and supplies is not covered by
the warranty. All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark parts and supplies, and may deliver
unpredictable results if third-party parts and supplies are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended
life may damage your Lexmark printer or its associated components.
Warning—Potential Damage: Supplies and parts without Return Program agreement terms may be reset and
remanufactured. However, the manufacturer’s warranty does not cover any damage caused by non-genuine
supplies or parts. Resetting counters on the supply or part without proper remanufacturing can cause
damage to your printer. After resetting the supply or part counter, your printer may display an error indicating
the presence of the reset item.
Ordering a toner cartridge
Notes:
The estimated cartridge yield is based on the ISO/IEC 19798 standard.
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may negatively aect actual yield.
Maintain the printer 181
background
Lexmark CX532 and CX635 Return Program toner cartridges
Item North America,
Australia, and
New Zealand
European
Economic Area,
Iceland,
Liechtenstein,
and Norway
Rest of Asia
Pacific
Latin America Rest of Europe,
Middle East, and
Africa
Return Program toner cartridges
Cyan 75M10C0 75M20C0 75M30C0 75M40C0 75M50C0
Magenta 75M10M0 75M20M0 75M30M0 75M40M0 75M50M0
Yellow 75M10Y0 75M20Y0 75M30Y0 75M40Y0 75M50Y0
Black 75M10K0 75M20K0 75M30K0 75M40K0 75M50K0
High Yield Return Program toner cartridges
1
Cyan 75M1HC0 75M2HC0 75M3HC0 75M4HC0 75M5HC0
Magenta 75M1HM0 75M2HM0 75M3HM0 75M4HM0 75M5HM0
Yellow 75M1HY0 75M2HY0 75M3HY0 75M4HY0 75M5HY0
Black 75M1HK0 75M2HK0 75M3HK0 75M4HK0 75M5HK0
Extra High Yield Return Program toner cartridges
2
Cyan 75M1XC0 75M2XC0 75M3XC0 75M4XC0 75M5XC0
Magenta 75M1XM0 75M2XM0 75M3XM0 75M4XM0 75M5XM0
Yellow 75M1XY0 75M2XY0 75M3XY0 75M4XY0 75M5XY0
Black 75M1XK0 75M2XK0 75M3XK0 75M4XK0 75M5XK0
1
Supported only in the Lexmark CX532 printer model.
2
Supported only in the Lexmark CX635 printer model.
For more information on countries in each region, go to
www.lexmark.com/regions.
Lexmark CX532 Regular toner cartridges
Item Worldwide
Cyan 75M0H20
Magenta 75M0H30
Yellow 75M0H40
Black 75M0H10
Lexmark CX635 Regular toner cartridges
Item Worldwide
Cyan 75M0X20
Magenta 75M0X30
Yellow 75M0X40
Maintain the printer 182
background
Item Worldwide
Black 75M0X10
Lexmark XC2335 Toner cartridges
Item North America, Australia, and New Zealand Europe, Middle East, and Africa
Cyan 24B7537 24B7549
Magenta 24B7538 24B7550
Yellow 24B7539 24B7551
Black 24B7540 24B7552
Ordering an imaging kit
Item Part number
Return Program imaging kit
Black Return Program imaging kit 75M0ZK0
Black and color Return Program imaging kit 75M0ZV0
Regular imaging kit
Black imaging kit 75M0Z10
Black and color imaging kit 75M0Z50
Ordering a waste toner bottle
Item Part number
Waste toner bottle 75M0W00
Ordering a developer unit
Item Part number
Cyan developer unit 75M0D20
Magenta developer unit 75M0D30
Yellow developer unit 75M0D40
Black developer unit 75M0D10
Ordering a maintenance kit
Match the maintenance kit to the printer voltage.
Notes:
Using certain types of paper may require more frequent replacement of the maintenance kit.
Maintain the printer 183
background
The maintenance kit includes a fuser and pick tires. These parts may be individually ordered and
replaced if necessary.
Item Part number
100 V fuser maintenance kit 41X4999
110 V fuser maintenance kit 41X5000
220 V fuser maintenance kit 41X5001
Note: Only an authorized service technician can replace the maintenance kit. Contact your service provider.
Replacing parts and supplies
Replacing a toner cartridge
1 Open door B.
Maintain the printer 184
background
2 Remove the used toner cartridge.
3 Unpack the new toner cartridge.
Maintain the printer 185
background
4 Insert the new toner cartridge until it clicks into place.
5 Close the door.
Replacing an imaging kit
1 Open door B.
2 Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Maintain the printer 186
background
3 Remove the right cover.
Maintain the printer 187
background
4 Remove the waste toner bottle.
5 Remove the toner cartridges.
Maintain the printer 188
background
6 Remove the used imaging kit.
7 Unpack the new imaging kit.
Black imaging kit Black and color imaging kit
Maintain the printer 189
background
Notes:
The black imaging kit includes the imaging kit and the black developer unit.
The black and color imaging kit includes the imaging kit and the black, cyan, magenta, and yellow
developer units.
When replacing the black imaging kit, save the cyan, magenta, and yellow developer units from the
used imaging kit.
8 Remove the packing material.
Note: If you are replacing the black imaging kit, then insert the magenta, cyan, and yellow developer
units into the new imaging kit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging kit to direct light. Extended exposure to light
may cause print quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the photoconductor drum. Doing so may aect the quality of
future print jobs.
Maintain the printer 190
background
9 Insert the new imaging kit until it is fully seated.
Maintain the printer 191
background
10 Insert the toner cartridges until they click into place.
Maintain the printer 192
background
11 Insert the waste toner bottle until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 193
background
12 Attach the right cover until it clicks into place.
13 Close door A, and then close door B.
Maintain the printer 194
background
Replacing the waste toner bottle
1 Open door B.
2 Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Maintain the printer 195
background
3 Remove the right cover.
4 Remove the used waste toner bottle.
Note: To avoid spilling the toner, place the bottle in an upright position.
5 Unpack the new waste toner bottle.
Maintain the printer 196
background
6 Insert the new waste toner bottle until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 197
background
7 Attach the right cover until it clicks into place.
8 Close door A, and then close door B.
Maintain the printer 198
background
Replacing a developer unit
1 Open door B.
2 Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Maintain the printer 199
background
3 Remove the right cover.
4 Remove the waste toner bottle.
Maintain the printer 200
background
5 Remove the toner cartridges.
Maintain the printer 201
background
6 Remove the imaging kit.
7 Remove the used developer unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging kit to direct light. Extended exposure to light
may cause print quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the photoconductor drum. Doing so may aect the quality of
future print jobs.
Maintain the printer 202
background
8 Remove the packing material.
9 Insert the new developer unit.
Maintain the printer 203
background
10 Insert the imaging kit until it is fully seated.
Maintain the printer 204
background
11 Insert the toner cartridges until they click into place.
Maintain the printer 205
background
12 Insert the waste toner bottle until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 206
background
13 Attach the right cover until it clicks into place.
14 Close door A, and then close door B.
Replacing the pick tires
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
Maintain the printer 207
background
3 Remove the tray.
4 Remove the used pick tires.
5 Unpack the new pick tires.
Maintain the printer 208
background
6 Insert the new pick tires.
Note: Make sure that the edges of the pick tire treads are facing downward.
7 Insert the tray.
8 Connect the power cord to the printer, and then to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
9 Turn on the printer.
Maintain the printer 209
background
Replacing the right cover
1 Open door B.
2 Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Maintain the printer 210
background
3 Remove the used right cover.
4 Remove door B from the used right cover.
5 Unpack the new right cover.
6 Attach door B to the new right cover.
Maintain the printer 211
background
7 Attach the new right cover until it clicks into place.
8 Close door A, and then close door B.
Replacing MarkNet N8450 Wireless Print Server
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock, if you are accessing the controller
board or installing optional hardware or memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn
the printer o, and unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any
other devices attached to the printer, then turn them o as well, and unplug any cables going into the
printer.
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
3 Using a flat-head screwdriver, remove the controller board shield.
Maintain the printer 212
background
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static
electricity. Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board components or
connectors.
4 Open door B.
Maintain the printer 213
background
5 Remove the used wireless print server.
6 Unpack the new wireless print server.
7 Insert the new wireless print server until it clicks into place.
8 Close door B.
Maintain the printer 214
background
9 Attach the controller board shield, and then install the screws.
10 Connect the power cord to the printer, and then to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
11 Turn on the printer.
Replacing the ADF rollers
1 Open door C.
Maintain the printer 215
background
2 Remove the used ADF pick roller.
Maintain the printer 216
background
3 Remove the used ADF separator roller.
4 Unpack the new ADF pick roller and ADF separator roller.
Maintain the printer 217
background
5 Insert the new ADF separator roller until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 218
background
6 Insert the new ADF pick roller until it clicks into place.
7 Close door C.
Maintain the printer 219
background
Replacing the scanner glass pad
1 Open the scanner cover.
2 Remove the used scanner glass pad.
3 Unpack the new scanner glass pad.
Maintain the printer 220
background
4 Align the new scanner glass pad to the scanner glass.
5 Close the scanner cover to attach the new scanner glass pad.
6 Open the scanner cover.
Maintain the printer 221
background
7 Apply pressure to the scanner glass pad to secure it.
8 Close the scanner cover.
Replacing the staple refill
1 Open the convenience stapler access door.
Maintain the printer 222
background
2 Remove the staple cartridge.
3 Remove the empty staple
refill.
4 Insert the new staple refill until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 223
background
5 Insert the staple cartridge, and then close the convenience stapler access door.
Note: Check the LED indicator status. The convenience stapler is ready to use when the blue light comes
on.
Replacing the convenience stapler power supply
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet, and then from the printer.
3 Unplug the power supply from the electrical outlet.
Maintain the printer 224
background
4 Remove the column cover and power supply cable.
Maintain the printer 225
background
5 Remove the convenience stapler.
6 Remove the used power supply.
7 Unpack the new power supply.
Maintain the printer 226
background
8 Insert the new power supply through the printer, and then connect it to the convenience stapler.
9 Install the convenience stapler.
Maintain the printer 227
background
10 Position the power supply properly.
11 Attach the column cover.
Note: Secure the power supply properly.
12 Connect one end of the stapler power cord to the power supply, and then the other end to the electrical
outlet.
13 Connect one end of the printer power cord to the printer, and then the other end to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
14 Turn on the printer.
Maintain the printer 228
background
Resetting the supply usage counters
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance >
Configuration
Menu > Supply Usage
And Counters.
2 Select the counter that you want to reset.
Warning—Potential Damage: Supplies and parts without Return Program agreement terms may be reset and
remanufactured. However, the manufacturer’s warranty does not cover any damage caused by non-genuine
supplies or parts. Resetting counters on the supply or part without proper remanufacturing can cause
damage to your printer. After resetting the supply or part counter, your printer may display an error indicating
the presence of the reset item.
Cleaning printer parts
Cleaning the printer
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
Notes:
Perform this task after every few months.
Damage to the printer caused by improper handling is not covered by the printer warranty.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Remove paper from the standard bin and multipurpose feeder.
3 Remove any dust, lint, and pieces of paper around the printer using a soft brush or vacuum.
4 Wipe the outside of the printer with a damp, soft, lintfree cloth.
Notes:
Do not use household cleaners or detergents, as they may damage the finish of the printer.
Make sure that all areas of the printer are dry after cleaning.
5 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Cleaning the touch screen
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electric shock when cleaning the exterior of the
printer, unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before
proceeding.
1 Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
2 Using a damp, soft, lintfree cloth, wipe the touch screen.
Maintain the printer 229
background
Notes:
Do not use household cleaners or detergents, as they may damage the touch screen.
Make sure that the touch screen is dry after cleaning.
3 Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or electrical shock, connect the power cord
to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily
accessible.
Cleaning the scanner
1 Open the scanner cover.
2 Using a damp, soft, lint-free cloth, wipe the following areas:
ADF glass pad
Maintain the printer 230
background
Scanner glass pad
ADF glass
Scanner glass
3 Close the scanner cover.
4 Open door C.
Maintain the printer 231
background
5 Using a damp, soft, lint-free cloth, wipe the following areas:
ADF glass pad in door C
ADF glass in door C
6 Close door C.
Maintain the printer 232
background
Cleaning the ADF rollers
1 Open door C.
2 Remove the ADF pick roller.
Maintain the printer 233
background
3 Remove the ADF separator roller.
4 Apply isopropyl alcohol to a soft, lint-free cloth, and then wipe the ADF pick roller and ADF separator roller.
Maintain the printer 234
background
5 Insert the ADF separator roller until it clicks into place.
Maintain the printer 235
background
6 Insert the ADF pick roller until it clicks into place.
7 Close door C.
Maintain the printer 236
background
Saving energy and paper
Configuring the power save mode settings
Sleep mode
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Power Management > Timeouts > Sleep Mode.
2 Specify the amount of time that the printer stays idle before it enters Sleep Mode.
Hibernate mode
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Power Management > Timeouts > Hibernate Timeout.
2 Select the amount of time that the printer stays idle before it enters Hibernate mode.
Notes:
For Hibernate Timeout to work, set Hibernate Timeout on Connection to Hibernate.
The Embedded Web Server is disabled when the printer is in Hibernate mode.
Adjusting the brightness of the display
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Preferences.
2 In the Screen Brightness menu, adjust the setting.
Conserving supplies
Print on both sides of the paper.
Note: Two-sided printing is the default setting in the print driver.
Print multiple pages on a single sheet of paper.
Use the preview feature to see how the document looks like before printing it.
Print one copy of the document to check its content and format for accuracy.
Moving the printer to another location
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: If the printer weight is greater than 20 kg (44 lb), then it may require
two or more people to lift it safely.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, use only the power cord
provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: When moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal
injury or printer damage:
Make sure that all doors and trays are closed.
Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer.
Maintain the printer 237
background
If the printer has separate floor-standing optional trays or output options attached to it, then disconnect
them before moving the printer.
If the printer has a caster base, then carefully roll it to the new location. Use caution when passing over
thresholds and breaks in
flooring.
If the printer does not have a caster base but is
configured
with optional trays or output options, then remove
the output options and lift the printer o the trays. Do not try to lift the printer and any options at the same
time.
Always use the handholds on the printer to lift it.
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the
options.
Keep the printer in an upright position.
Avoid severe jarring movements.
Make sure that your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.
Make sure that there is adequate clearance around the printer.
Note: Damage to the printer caused by improper moving is not covered by the printer warranty.
Shipping the printer
For shipping instructions, go to
https://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support.
Maintain the printer 238
background
Troubleshoot a problem
Print quality problems
Find the image that resembles the print quality problem you are having, and then click the link below it to read
problem-solving steps.
“Blank or white pages” on
page 247
“Dark print” on page 248 “Ghost images” on page 250 “Gray or colored background”
on page 251
“Incorrect margins” on
page 252
“Light print” on page 253
“Missing colors” on page
255
“Mottled print and dots” on
page 256
“Paper curl” on page
257
“Print crooked or skewed”
on page 258
“Solid color or black images”
on page 259
“Text or images cut
o”
on
page 260
Troubleshoot a problem 239
background
“Toner easily rubs o” on
page 261
“Uneven print density” on
page 262
“Horizontal dark lines” on
page 263
“Vertical dark lines” on
page 264
“Horizontal white lines
on page 265
“Vertical white lines” on
page 266
“Repeating defects” on
page 268
Printer error codes
Error codes Error message Solution
8.01 Close all doors. Keep all doors closed unless
performing maintenance.
9.00 Printer had to restart. Last job may be
incomplete.
Touch Continue to clear the message
and continue printing.
11.11, 11.21, 11.31, 11.41 Load <source/> with <type/>
<size/>.
Open the indicated tray, and then
load paper. For more information, see
“Loading trays” on page 47.
11.12, 11.22, 11.32, 11.42 Load <source/> with <type/>
<size/> <orientation/>.
11.81 Load <source/> with <type/>
<size/>.
Adjust the paper guides, and then
load paper. For more information, see
“Loading the manual feeder” on
page 49.
11.82 Load <source/> with <type/>
<size/> <orientation/>.
Troubleshoot a problem 240
background
Error codes Error message Solution
11.91 Load multipurpose feeder
with <type/> <size/>.
Open the multipurpose feeder, and
then load paper. For more
information, see
“Loading the
multipurpose feeder” on page 51.
11.92 Load multipurpose feeder
with <type/> <size/>
<orientation/>.
12.11 Change <source/> to <type/>
<size/>.
Open the indicated tray, remove
paper, and then load the correct
paper type and size. For more
information, see
“Loading trays” on
page 47.
12.12 Change <source/> to <type/>
<size/> <orientation/>.
12.91 Change multipurpose feeder
to <type/> <size/>.
Remove paper, and then load the
correct paper type and size. For more
information, see
“Loading the
multipurpose feeder” on page 51.
12.92 Change multipurpose feeder
to <type/> <size/>
<orientation/>.
29.08 Remove packing material.
1 Open door A.
2 Remove the red packing material
behind the front door.
3 Open door B.
4 Remove the packing material
near the toner cartridges.
5 Close door B, and then close
door A.
31.35z Reinstall missing or unresponsive
waste toner bottle.
1 Open door A.
Warning—Potential
Damage: The inside of the
printer might be hot. To reduce
the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to
cool before touching it.
2 Open door B.
3 Remove the right cover.
4 Remove the waste toner bottle.
5 Align, and then insert the waste
toner bottle.
6 Align, and then attach the right
cover.
7 Close door B, and then close
door A.
31.40z, 31.41z, 31.42z, 31.43z Reinstall missing or
unresponsive [color]
cartridge.
1 Open door B.
2 Remove the cartridge.
3 Insert the cartridge.
4 Close door B.
Troubleshoot a problem 241
background
Error codes Error message Solution
31.60z Reinstall missing or unresponsive
black imaging kit.
1 Open door A.
Warning—Potential
Damage: The inside of the
printer might be hot. To reduce
the risk of injury from a hot
component, allow the surface to
cool before touching it.
2 Open door B.
3 Remove all toner cartridges.
4 Remove the right cover.
5 Remove the waste toner bottle.
6 Pull out the imaging kit.
7 Insert the imaging kit until it is
fully seated.
8 Align, and then insert the waste
toner bottle.
9 Align, and then attach the right
cover.
10 Insert the toner cartridges.
11 Close door B, and then close
door A.
31.65z Reinstall missing, unplugged, or
unresponsive black and color
imaging kit.
32.40z, 32.41z, 32.42z, 32.43z Replace unsupported [color]
cartridge.
For more information, see
“Replacing
a toner cartridge” on page 184.
32.65z Replace unsupported black and color
imaging kit.
For more information, see
“Replacing
an imaging kit” on page 186.
33.40, 33.41, 33.42, 33.43 Non-Lexmark [color]
cartridge, see User's
Guide.
For more information, see
“NonLexmark supply” on page 289.
33.65 Non-Lexmark black and color
imaging kit, see User's Guide.
37.1 Insucient memory to collate job. Try one or more of the following:
To uch Continue to print the part
of the job that is stored and to
begin collating the rest of the print
job.
Cancel the current print job.
37.3 Insucient memory, some held jobs
were deleted.
Touch Continue to clear the message
and continue printing.
38.1 Memory full. Try one or more of the following:
To uch Cancel job to clear the
message.
Print the document in several
parts, or send it to another printer.
Install more printer memory.
Troubleshoot a problem 242
background
Error codes Error message Solution
39.1 Complex page, some data may not
have printed.
Try one or more of the following:
To uch Continue to clear the
message and continue printing.
Cancel the current print job.
Install more printer memory.
Reduce the complexity and size of
the print job before sending it to
print again.
Reduce the number of pages
in the print job.
Reduce the number and size
of any downloaded fonts.
Delete any unnecessary fonts
or macros from the print job.
Reduce the number of
graphics in the print job.
42.yy Replace [color] cartridge,
printer region mismatch.
For more information, see
“Replace
cartridge, printer region mismatch”
on page 288.
43.40y, 43.41y, 43.42y, 43.43y [Color] cartridge problem.
1 Open door B.
2 Remove the toner cartridge.
3 Insert the toner cartridge.
4 Close door B.
If the problem persists, then replace
the cartridge.
43.40z, 43.41z, 43.42z, 43.43z Replace defective [color]
cartridge.
For more information, see
“Replacing
a toner cartridge” on page 184.
55.1 Error reading USB drive. Remove
USB.
Remove the flash drive to continue.
55.2 Error reading USB hub. Remove hub. Remove the USB hub to continue.
Troubleshoot a problem 243
background
Error codes Error message Solution
58 Too many trays attached.
Only <x/> tray/s can be
supported.
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the
electrical outlet, and then from
the printer.
3 Remove one or more trays.
4 Connect the power cord to the
electrical outlet, and then turn on
the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL
INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or
electrical shock, connect the power
cord to an appropriately rated and
properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily
accessible.
59 Incompatible tray [x].
1 Turn o the printer.
2 Unplug the power cord from the
electrical outlet, and then from
the printer.
3 Remove the indicated tray.
4 Connect the power cord to the
electrical outlet, and then turn on
the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL
INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or
electrical shock, connect the power
cord to an appropriately rated and
properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily
accessible.
61 Remove defective disk. Replace the defective storage drive.
62 Disk full. Try one or more of the following:
To uch Continue to clear the
message.
Delete fonts, macros, and other
data stored in the intelligent
storage drive.
Install an intelligent storage drive.
Troubleshoot a problem 244
background
Error codes Error message Solution
63 Format the disk. Formatting now wipes all information
from the storage drive.
To format the disk, do the following:
1 From the home screen, touch
Settings > Device >
Maintenance > Out of Service
Erase.
2 Touch Sanitize all information
on hard disk orErase Intelligent
Storage Drive, and then touch
ERASE.
71.01 Fax Station Name not set up. Contact
system administrator.
For more information, see
“Setting up
the fax function using analog fax” on
page 33.
71.02 Fax Station Number not set up.
Contact system administrator.
71.03 No analog phone line connected to
modem, fax is disabled.
Check the connection and the line for
a signal. For more information, see
“Setting up fax using a standard
telephone line” on page 35.
71.06 Unable to connect to HTTPS Fax
Server.
Connection to HTTPS Fax Server is
disconnected. Check the Internet
connection of the printer.
71.12 Memory full, cannot print faxes. Touch Print All to print as many of the
faxes as have been saved.
71.13 Memory full. Cannot send faxes. Try one or more of the following:
Continue and try sending the fax
again.
Scan the original document one
page at a time, dial the fax
number, and then scan the
document.
71.4 Incorrect printer time. To set the correct printer time, do the
following:
1 From the home screen, touch
Settings > Device > Preferences.
2 Touch Date and Time, and then
set the correct time.
72.01 E-mail SMTP server not set up.
Contact system administrator.
Try either of the following:
Set up your email function. For
more information, see
“Configuring the email SMTP
settings” on page 39.
Disable the error message. For
more information, see
“Disabling
the 'SMTP server not set up' error
message” on page 292.
Troubleshoot a problem 245
background
Error codes Error message Solution
80.11 Maintenance kit low. Touch Continue to clear the
message.
80.21 Maintenance kit very low.
84.01, 84.09 Black and color imaging kit nearly
low.
Touch Continue to clear the
message.
84.11, 84.19 Black and color imaging kit low.
84.21, 84.23, 84.29 Black and color imaging kit very low.
84.31, 84.33 Replace [color] imaging
kit, recommended life
exceeded.
For more information, see
“Replacing
an imaging kit” on page 186.
84.41, 84.43, 84.48 Replace [color] imaging kit
to resume printing.
88.00, 88.08, 88.09 [Color] cartridge nearly
low.
Touch Continue to clear the
message.
88.10, 88.18, 88.19 [Color] cartridge low.
88.20, 88.28, 88.29 [Color] cartridge very low.
88.30, 88.37, 88.38 Replace [color] cartridge,
<num/> estimated pages
remain.
For more information, see
“Replacing
a toner cartridge” on page 184.
Replace [color] cartridge.
88.40, 88.47, 88.48 Replace [color] cartridge,
0 pages remain.
200.02, 200.03, 200.05, 200.06,
200.12, 200.13, 200.15, 200.16,
200.22, 200.23, 200.25, 200.32,
200.33, 200.35, 200.43, 200.45,
200.91, 200.99, 202.03, 202.04,
202.05, 202.13, 202.14, 202.15,
202.23, 202.24, 202.25, 202.33,
202.34, 202.35, 202.43, 202.44,
202.45, 202.91, 232.02, 232.03,
232.05, 232.12, 232.13, 232.15,
232.22, 232.23, 232.25, 232.32,
232.33, 232.35, 232.42, 232.43,
232.45, 232.92, 232.93, 232.95,
241.91
Paper jam, [jam header].
[xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in door A” on page 279.
Troubleshoot a problem 246
background
Error codes Error message Solution
241.05, 241.82, 241.83, 241.84, 241.91,
242.05, 242.06, 242.21, 242.22,
242.25, 242.26, 242.31, 242.32,
242.33, 242.35, 242.36, 242.43,
242.45, 242.70, 242.72, 242.91,
242.92, 242.93, 242.95, 243.31,
243.32, 243.35, 243.36, 243.41,
243.42, 243.43, 243.45, 243.70,
243.71, 243.72, 243.73, 243.74,
243.75, 243.76, 243.80, 243.81,
243.82, 243.83, 243.84, 243.85,
243.86, 243.91, 243.92, 243.93,
243.95, 243.96, 243.97, 244.45,
244.46, 244.70, 244.71, 244.72,
244.73, 244.74, 244.75, 244.76,
244.80, 244.81, 244.82, 244.83,
244.84 244.85, 244.86, 244.91,
244.92, 244.93, 244.95, 244.96,
244.97
Paper jam, [jam header].
[xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in trays” on page 282.
242.05 Paper jam, [jam header].
[xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in the multipurpose feeder” on
page 284.
251.xx Paper jam, [jam header].
[xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in the manual feeder” on page 283.
200.16, 241.8y Paper loading error, [jam
header]. [xxx.yy]
For more information, see
“Paper jam
in trays” on page 282.
280.11, 280.13, 280.15, 280.91, 280.93,
280.95, 284.11, 284.13, 284.15, 284.91,
284.93, 284.95, 295.01, 680.10,
680.20, 680.40
Scanner jam. [xxx.yy] For more information, see
“Paper jam
in the automatic document feeder”
on page 278.
Printing problems
Print quality is poor
Blank or white pages
Troubleshoot a problem 247
background
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the printer is using a genuine and supported Lexmark
toner cartridge.
Note: If the cartridge is not supported, then install a
supported one.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing blank or white pages?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing blank or white pages?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Dark print
Note: Before solving the problem, print the quality sample pages to determine the missing color. From the
home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 248
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, reduce the toner
darkness from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Print >
Quality > Toner Darkness.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the settings match the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 4. Go to step 6.
Step 4
Make sure that the paper has no texture or rough finishes.
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?
Go to step 5. Go to step 6.
Step 5
a Replace textured or rough paper with plain paper.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 249
background
Action Yes No
Step 6
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the print too dark?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Ghost images
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Load the tray with the correct paper type and weight.
b Print the document.
Do ghost images appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do ghost images appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 250
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Do ghost images appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Gray or colored background
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, increase toner darkness
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Print >
Quality > Toner Darkness.
b Print the document.
Does gray or colored background appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Does gray or colored background appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 251
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Does gray or colored background appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Incorrect margins
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Adjust the paper guides in the tray to the correct position for
the paper loaded.
b Print the document.
Are the margins correct?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 252
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
Note:
b Print the document.
Are the margins correct?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Light print
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Perform Color Adjust.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, increase toner darkness
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Print >
Quality > Toner Darkness.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 253
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Turn o Color Saver.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality > Color
Saver.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
Check if paper has texture or rough finishes.
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?
Go to step 6. Go to step 7.
Step 6
a Replace textured or rough paper with plain paper.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 7. The problem is
solved.
Step 7
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the print light?
Go to step 8. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 254
background
Action Yes No
Step 8
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the print too light?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Missing colors
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
a Remove the color imaging kit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit to direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended
exposure to light may cause print quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit. Doing so
may aect the quality of future print jobs.
b Remove the toner cartridge of the missing color.
c Remove, and then insert the developer unit of the missing color.
d Insert the toner cartridge of the missing color.
e Insert the color imaging kit.
f Print the document.
Are some colors missing on print?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 255
background
Mottled print and dots
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check the printer for leaked toner contamination.
Is the printer free of leaked toner?
Go to step 2. Contact customer
support.
Step 2
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Check if the paper size and paper type settings match the
paper loaded.
Note: Make sure that the paper does not have texture or
rough finishes.
Do the settings match?
Go to step 4. Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
and paper type from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the settings match the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the print mottled?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the print mottled?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 256
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the print mottled?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Paper curl
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Adjust the guides in the tray to the correct position for the paper
loaded.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 257
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
Print on the other side of the paper.
a Remove paper, flip it over, and then reload paper.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Is the paper curled?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Print crooked or skewed
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 258
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Pull out the tray.
b Remove the paper, and then load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
c Squeeze and slide the paper guides to the correct position for
the size of the paper you are loading.
d Insert the tray.
e Print the document.
Is the print crooked or skewed?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Check if you are printing on a supported paper.
b Print the document.
Is the print crooked or skewed?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Solid color or black images
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 259
background
Action Yes No
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing solid color or black images?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Text or images cut o
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Adjust the paper guides in the tray to the correct position for
the paper loaded.
b Print the document.
Is the text or image clipped?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 260
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Is the text or image clipped?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may
aect
the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the text or image clipped?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Toner easily rubs o
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 261
background
Action Yes No
1 Depending on your operating system, specify the
paper type from the Printing Preferences or Print
dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper
loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer
control panel. From the home screen, touch
Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration
> Paper
Size/Type.
2 Print the document.
Does the toner rub
o?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is solved.
Uneven print density
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Is the print density uneven?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 262
background
Horizontal dark lines
Notes:
Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
If horizontal dark lines keep appearing on the prints, then see the “Repeating defects” topic.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 263
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do horizontal dark lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Vertical dark lines
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do vertical dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 264
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you use it.
b Print the document.
Do vertical dark lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do vertical dark lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Horizontal white lines
Notes:
Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
If horizontal white lines keep appearing on the prints, then see the “Repeating defects” topic.
Troubleshoot a problem 265
background
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Load the specified paper source with the recommended paper
type.
b Print the document.
Do horizontal white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may
aect
the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do horizontal white lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Vertical white lines
Troubleshoot a problem 266
background
Note: Before solving the problem, print the Print Quality Test Pages. From the home screen, touch Settings >
Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded in
the tray.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray
Configuration
> Paper Size/Type.
b Print the document.
Do vertical white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
Check if you are using the recommended paper type.
a Load the specified paper source with the recommended paper
type.
b Print the document.
Do vertical white lines appear on prints?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Step 3
a Remove the color imaging kit, and then remove the black
imaging unit.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the color
imaging kit and black imaging unit to direct light for more
than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light may cause print
quality problems.
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the
photoconductor drum under the color imaging kit and black
imaging unit. Doing so may aect the quality of future print
jobs.
b Insert the black imaging unit, and then insert the color imaging
kit.
c Print the document.
Do vertical white lines appear on prints?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 267
background
Repeating defects
Note: Before solving the problem, print the quality sample pages to determine the cause of the repeating
defects. From the home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Action Yes No
a Using the Maintenance Defect Ruler, measure the distance
between the repeating defects on the aected color page.
b Replace the supply item that matches the measurement on the
aected color page.
Imaging kit
94.5 mm (3.72 in.)
29.9 mm (1.18 in.)
23.2 mm (0.91 in.)
Developer unit
43.6 mm (1.72 in.)
45 mm (1.77 in.)
Transfer module
37.7 mm (1.48 in.)
78.5 mm (3.09 in.)
55 mm (2.17 in.)
28.3 mm (1.11 in.)
Fuser
79.8 mm (3.14 in.)
94.3 mm (3.71 in.)
c Print the Print Quality Test Pages.
Do the defects still appear?
Take note of the
distance, and then
contact
customer
support or your
service
representative.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 268
background
Print jobs do not print
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the document you are trying to print, open the Print
dialog, and then check if you have selected the correct printer.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check if the printer is on.
b Resolve any error messages that appear on the display.
c Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Check if the ports are working and if the cables are securely
connected to the computer and the printer.
For more information, see the setup documentation that came
with the printer.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on
the printer.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Remove, and then reinstall the print driver.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 269
background
Confidential and other held documents do not print
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the control panel, check if the documents appear in the
Held Jobs list.
Note: If the documents are not listed, then print the
documents using the Print and Hold options.
b Print the documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
The print job may contain a formatting error or invalid data.
Delete the print job, and then send it again.
For PDF files, generate a new file, and then print the
documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
If you are printing from the Internet, then the printer may be reading
the multiple job titles as duplicates.
For Windows users
a Open the Printing Preferences dialog.
b From the Print and Hold tab, click Use Print and Hold, and then
click Keep duplicate documents.
c Enter a PIN, and then save the changes.
d Send the print job.
For Macintosh users
a Save and name each job dierently.
b Send the job individually.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Delete some held jobs to free up printer memory.
b Print the documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Add printer memory.
b Print the documents.
Are the documents printed?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 270
background
Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if you are printing on the correct paper.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed on the correct paper?
Go to step 2. Load the correct
paper size and paper
type.
Step 2
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size
and paper type from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Note: You can also change the settings on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Make sure that the settings match the paper loaded.
c Print the document.
Is the document printed on the correct paper?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Check if the trays are linked.
For more information, see
“Linking trays” on page 53.
b Print the document.
Is the document printed from the correct tray?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Slow printing
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the printer cable is securely connected to the
printer and to the computer, print server, option, or other network
device.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a Make sure that the printer is not in Quiet Mode.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance
> Configuration Menu > Device Operations > Quiet Mode.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 271
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Depending on your operating system, specify the print
resolution from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
b Set the resolution to 4800 CQ.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 4. The problem is
solved.
Step 4
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality > Print
Resolution.
b Set the resolution to 4800 CQ.
c Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 5. The problem is
solved.
Step 5
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type
from the Printing Preferences or Print dialog.
Notes:
Make sure that the setting matches the paper loaded.
You can also change the setting on the printer control
panel. From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper >
Tray Conguration > Paper Size/Type.
Heavier paper prints more slowly.
Paper narrower than letter, A4, and legal may print more
slowly.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 6. The problem is
solved.
Step 6
a Make sure that the printer settings for texture and weight match
the paper being loaded.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Media
Configuration
> Media Types.
Note: Rough paper texture and heavy paper weight may print
more slowly.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 7. The problem is
solved.
Step 7
Remove held jobs.
Is the printer printing slow?
Go to step 8. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 272
background
Action Yes No
Step 8
a Make sure that the printer is not overheating.
Notes:
Allow the printer to cool down after a long print job.
Observe the recommended ambient temperature for the
printer. For more information, see
“Selecting a location
for the printer” on page 22.
b Print the document.
Is the printer printing slow?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
The printer is not responding
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check if the power cord is connected to the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire or
electrical shock, connect the power cord to an appropriately
rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the
product and easily accessible.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check if the electrical outlet is turned o by a switch or breaker.
Is the electrical outlet turned o by a switch or breaker?
Turn on the switch or
reset the breaker.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check if the printer is on.
Is the printer on?
Go to step 4. Turn on the printer.
Step 4
Check if the printer is in Sleep or Hibernate mode.
Is the printer in Sleep or Hibernate mode?
Press the power
button to wake the
printer.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
Check if the cables connecting the printer and the computer are
inserted to the correct ports.
Are the cables inserted to the correct ports?
Go to step 6. Insert the cables to
the correct ports.
Troubleshoot a problem 273
background
Action Yes No
Step 6
Turn o the printer, install the hardware options, and then turn on
the printer.
For more information, see the documentation that came with the
option.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 7.
Step 7
Install the correct print driver.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 8.
Step 8
Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on the
printer.
Is the printer responding?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Unable to read flash drive
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check if the printer is not busy processing another print, copy,
scan, or fax job.
Is the printer ready?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Step 2
Wait for the printer to
finish
processing the other job.
Remove, and then insert the flash drive.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check if the flash drive is inserted into the front USB port.
Note: The flash drive does not work when it is inserted into the
rear USB port.
Is the
flash
drive inserted into the correct port?
Go to step 5. Go to step 4.
Step 4
Insert the flash drive into the correct port.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Troubleshoot a problem 274
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
Check if the flash drive is supported. For more information, see
“Supported flash drives and file types” on page 78.
Is the flash drive supported?
Go to step 7. Go to step 6.
Step 6
Insert a supported flash drive.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 7.
Step 7
Remove, and then insert the flash drive.
Does the printer recognize the flash drive?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Enabling the USB port
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > USB > Enable USB Port.
Clearing jams
Avoiding jams
Load paper properly
Make sure that the paper lies flat in the tray.
Correct loading of paper Incorrect loading of paper
Do not load or remove a tray while the printer is printing.
Do not load too much paper. Make sure that the stack height is below the maximum paper fill indicator.
Troubleshoot a problem 275
background
Do not slide paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.
Make sure that the paper guides are positioned correctly and are not pressing tightly against the paper or
envelopes.
Push the tray firmly into the printer after loading paper.
Use recommended paper
Use only recommended paper or specialty media.
Do not load paper that is wrinkled, creased, damp, bent, or curled.
Flex, fan, and align the paper edges before loading.
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.
Do not mix paper sizes, weights, or types in the same tray.
Make sure that the paper size and type are set correctly on the computer or printer control panel.
Store paper according to manufacturer recommendations.
Identifying jam locations
Notes:
When Jam Assist is set to On, the printer flushes blank pages or pages with partial prints after a jammed
page has been cleared. Check your printed output for blank pages.
When Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto, the printer reprints jammed pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 276
background
Jam locations
1 Automatic document feeder
2 Door A
3 Trays
4 Multipurpose feeder
5 Manual feeder
Troubleshoot a problem 277
background
Paper jam in the automatic document feeder
Paper jam under the ADF top cover
1 Remove all original documents from the ADF tray.
2 Open door C.
3 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
4 Close door C.
Paper jam under the ADF output bin
1 Remove all original documents from the ADF tray.
2 Lift the ADF tray, and then remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Troubleshoot a problem 278
background
3 Place the ADF tray back into place.
Paper jam in door A
Paper jam below the fuser
1 Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Warning—Potential Damage: To prevent damage from electrostatic discharge, touch any exposed metal
frame of the printer before accessing or touching interior areas of the printer.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Troubleshoot a problem 279
background
3 Close door A.
Paper jam in the fuser
1 Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Warning—Potential Damage: To prevent damage from electrostatic discharge, touch any exposed metal
frame of the printer before accessing or touching interior areas of the printer.
2 Open the fuser access door, and then remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Troubleshoot a problem 280
background
3 Close door A.
Paper jam in the duplex unit
1 Open door A.
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a
hot component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.
Warning—Potential Damage: To prevent damage from electrostatic discharge, touch any exposed metal
frame of the printer before accessing or touching interior areas of the printer.
Troubleshoot a problem 281
background
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Close door A.
Paper jam in trays
1 Remove the tray.
Troubleshoot a problem 282
background
Warning—Potential Damage: A sensor inside the optional tray is easily damaged by static electricity.
Touch a metal surface before removing the jammed paper in the tray.
2 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
3 Insert the tray.
Paper jam in the manual feeder
Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
Troubleshoot a problem 283
background
Paper jam in the multipurpose feeder
Note: The multipurpose feeder is available only if the optional 650-sheet duo tray is installed.
1 Remove paper from the multipurpose feeder, and then close it.
2 Remove the tray.
3 Remove the jammed paper.
Note: Make sure that all paper fragments are removed.
4 Insert the tray.
5 Open the multipurpose feeder, and then reload paper.
Network connection problems
Cannot open Embedded Web Server
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the printer is on.
b Access the printer Embedded Web Server (EWS).
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 284
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Make sure that the printer IP address is correct.
Notes:
View the IP address on the home screen.
An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated
by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Make sure that you installed a supported browser:
Internet Explorer version 11 or later
Microsoft Edge
Safari version 6 or later
Google Chrome
TM
version 32 or later
Mozilla Firefox version 24 or later
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Check if the network connection is working.
Note: If the connection is not working, then contact your
administrator.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
a Make sure that the cable connections to the printer and print
server are secure. For more information, see the
documentation that came with the print server.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 6.
Step 6
a Check if the web proxy servers are disabled.
Note: If the servers are disabled, then contact your
administrator.
b Access the EWS.
Can you open the EWS?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 285
background
Cannot connect the printer to the WiFi network
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that Active Adapter is set to Auto.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Network
Overview > Active Adapter > Auto.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check if the correct WiFi network is selected.
Note: Some routers may share the default SSID.
Are you connecting to the correct WiFi network?
Go to step 4. Go to step 3.
Step 3
Connect to the correct WiFi network. For more information, see
“Connecting the printer to a WiFi network” on page 68.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
Check the wireless security mode.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless
> Wireless Security Mode.
Is the correct wireless security mode selected?
Go to step 6. Go to step 5.
Step 5
Select the correct wireless security mode.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 6.
Step 6
Make sure that you entered the correct network password.
Note: Take note of the spaces, numbers, and capitalization in the
password.
Can the printer connect to the WiFi network?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 286
background
Hardware options problems
Cannot detect internal option
Action Yes No
Step 1
Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on the
printer.
Does the printer detect the internal option?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Print the Menu Settings Page, and then check if the internal option
appears in the Installed Features list.
Is the internal option listed?
Go to step 4. Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check if the internal option is installed properly into the controller
board.
a Turn o the printer, and then unplug the power cord from the
electrical outlet.
b Make sure that the internal option is installed into the
appropriate connector on the controller board.
c Connect the power cord to the electrical outlet, and then turn
on the printer.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord to an
appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily accessible.
Does the printer detect the internal option?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Check if the internal option is available in the print driver.
Note: If necessary, manually add the internal option in the
print driver to make it available for print jobs. For more
information, see
Adding available options in the print driver”
on page 56.
b Print the document.
Does the printer detect the internal option?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Defective flash detected
Try one or more of the following:
Replace the defective intelligent storage drive.
From the home screen, touch Continue to ignore the message and continue printing.
Troubleshoot a problem 287
background
Cancel the current print job.
Not enough free space in flash memory for resources
Try one or more of the following:
Tou ch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the flash memory.
Install a hard disk.
Note: Downloaded fonts and macros that are not previously stored in the flash memory are deleted.
Red light on the convenience stapler
Try one or more of the following:
Close the staple access door.
Remove the loose staples.
Note: After removing loose staples, two priming cycles are required before stapling. Insert a stack of
paper into the stapler three times. The stapling starts at the third insertion.
Replace the staple cartridge.
Issues with supplies
Replace cartridge, printer region mismatch
To correct this problem, purchase a cartridge with the correct region that matches the printer region, or
purchase a worldwide cartridge.
The first number in the message after 42 indicates the region of the printer.
The second number in the message after 42 indicates the region of the cartridge.
Printer and toner cartridge regions
Region Numeric code
Worldwide or Undefined region 0
North America (United States, Canada), Australia, New Zealand 1
European Economic Area, Iceland, Liechtenstein, and Norway 2
Asia Pacific 3
Latin America 4
Rest of Europe, Middle East, Africa 5
Invalid region 9
Note: To
find
the region settings of the printer and toner cartridge, print the print quality test pages.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting > Print Quality Test Pages.
Troubleshoot a problem 288
background
NonLexmark supply
The printer has detected a nonLexmark supply or part installed in the printer.
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-
party supplies or parts may aect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging
components.
All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts and may deliver unpredictable
results if third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended life may
damage your Lexmark printer or associated components.
Warning—Potential Damage: Use of third-party supplies or parts can
aect
warranty coverage.
Damage caused by the use of third-party supplies or parts may not be covered by the warranty.
To accept any and all of these risks and to proceed with the use of non-genuine supplies or parts in your
printer, touch and hold the error message on the display using two fingers for 15 seconds. When a
confirmation dialog box appears, touch Continue.
If you do not want to accept these risks, then remove the third-party supply or part from your printer and
install a genuine Lexmark supply or part. For more information, see
“Using genuine Lexmark parts and
supplies” on page 181.
If the printer does not print after clearing the error message, then reset the supply usage counter.
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Configuration Menu > Supply Usage
And Counters.
2 Select the part or supply that you want to reset, and then touch Start.
3 Read the warning message, and then touch Continue.
4 Using two fingers, touch the display for 15 seconds to clear the message.
Note: If you are unable to reset the supply usage counters, then return the supply item to the place of
purchase.
Paper feed problems
Envelope seals when printing
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Use an envelope that has been stored in a dry environment.
Note: Printing on envelopes with high moisture content can
seal the
flaps.
b Send the print job.
Does the envelope seal when printing?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 289
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Make sure that paper type is set to Envelope.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Send the print job.
Does the envelope seal when printing?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Collated printing does not work
Action Yes No
Step 1
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Layout >
Collate.
b Tou ch On [1,2,1,2,1,2].
c Print the document.
Is the document collated correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a From the document that you are trying to print, open the Print
dialog, and then select Collate.
b Print the document.
Is the document collated correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Reduce the number of pages to print.
b Print the document.
Are the pages collated correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Tray linking does not work
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the trays contain the same paper size and paper type.
b Check if the paper guides are positioned correctly.
c Print the document.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 290
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Set the paper size and paper type to match the paper loaded
in the linked trays.
c Print the document.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Make sure that Tray Linking is set to Automatic. For more
information, see
“Linking trays” on page 53.
b Print the document.
Do the trays link correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Paper frequently jams
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Remove the tray.
b Check if paper is loaded correctly.
Notes:
Make sure that the paper guides are positioned correctly.
Make sure that the stack height is below the maximum
paper
fill
indicator.
Make sure to print on recommended paper size and type.
c Insert the tray.
d Print the document.
Do paper jams occur frequently?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Paper > Tray
Configuration > Paper Size/Type.
b Set the correct paper size and type.
c Print the document.
Do paper jams occur frequently?
Go to step 3. The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 291
background
Action Yes No
Step 3
a Load paper from a fresh package.
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store
paper in its original wrapper until you are ready to use it.
b Print the document.
Do paper jams occur frequently?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Jammed pages are not reprinted
Action Yes No
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Notifications
> Jam Content Recovery.
b In the Jam Recovery menu, touch On or Auto.
c Print the document.
Are the jammed pages reprinted?
The problem is
solved.
Contact customer
support.
E-mailing problems
Disabling the “SMTP server not set up” error message
From the home screen, touch Settings > E
mail > Email Setup > Disable “SMTP Server not set up” error >
On.
To prevent the error from happening again, do one or more of the following:
Update the printer firmware. For more information, see
“Updating firmware” on page 55.
Configure the email SMTP settings. For more information, see
“Configuring the email SMTP settings” on
page 39.
Troubleshoot a problem 292
background
Cannot send emails
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the email SMTP settings are configured correctly.
For more information, see “Configuring the email SMTP settings”
on page 39.
Can you send an email?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that you are using the correct password. Depending on
your email service provider, use your account password, app
password, or authentication password. For more information, see
“Configuring
the email SMTP settings” on page 39.
Can you send an email?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the
network is connected to the Internet.
Can you send an email?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Faxing problems
Caller ID is not shown
Note: These instructions apply only to printers that support analog fax. For more information, see the
Setting
up the printer to fax section.
Action Yes No
Enable caller ID.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax
Receive Settings > Admin Controls > Enable Caller ID.
Does the caller ID appear?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 293
background
Cannot send or receive faxes using analog fax
Action Yes No
Step 1
Resolve any error messages that appear on the display.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that the cable connections for the following equipment
are secure:
Telephone
Handset
Answering machine
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check for a dial tone.
Call the fax number to check if it is working properly.
If you are using the On Hook Dial feature, then turn up the
volume to check if you hear a dial tone.
Can you hear a dial tone?
Go to step 5. Go to step 4.
Step 4
Check the telephone wall jack.
a Connect the analog telephone directly to the wall jack.
b Listen for a dial tone.
c If you do not hear a dial tone, then use a
dierent
telephone
cable.
d If you still do not hear a dial tone, then connect the analog
telephone to a
dierent
wall jack.
e If you hear a dial tone, then connect the printer to that wall jack.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Troubleshoot a problem 294
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
Check if the printer is connected to an analog phone service or to
the correct digital connector.
If you are using an Integrated Services for Digital Network
(ISDN) telephone service, then connect to an analog telephone
port of an ISDN terminal adapter. For more information, contact
your ISDN provider.
If you are using DSL, then connect to a DSL filter or router that
supports analog use. For more information, contact your DSL
provider.
If you are using a private branch exchange (PBX) telephone
service, then make sure that you are connecting to an analog
connection on the PBX. If none exists, then consider installing
an analog telephone line for the fax machine.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 6.
Step 6
Temporarily disconnect other equipment and disable other
telephone services.
a Disconnect other equipment (such as answering machines,
computers, modems, or telephone line splitters) between the
printer and the telephone line.
b Disable call waiting and voice mail. For more information,
contact your telephone company.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 7.
Step 7
Scan the original document one page at a time.
a Dial the fax number.
b Scan the document.
Can you send or receive a fax?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Troubleshoot a problem 295
background
Can receive but not send faxes using analog fax
Action Yes No
Step 1
Load an original document properly into the ADF tray or on the
scanner glass.
Can you send faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Set up the shortcut number properly.
Check if the shortcut number is set for the telephone number
that you want to dial.
Dial the telephone number manually.
Can you send faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Can send but not receive faxes using analog fax
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the paper source is not empty.
Can you receive faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Check the ring count delay settings.
From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax
Receive Settings > Rings to Answer.
Can you receive faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
If the printer is printing blank pages, then see
“Blank or white
pages” on page 247.
Can you receive faxes?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot set up etherFAX
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check the printer connectivity.
a Print the Network Setup Page. From the home screen, touch
Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
b Check the network status.
Is the printer connected to the network?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 296
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
Make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the
network is connected to the Internet.
Can you set up etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Make sure that etherFAX is set up correctly. For more information,
see
“Setting up the fax function using etherFAX” on page 34.
Can you set up etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to
https://www.etherfa
x.net/lexmark.
Cannot send or receive faxes using etherFAX
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that the printer is connected to a network and that the
network is connected to the Internet.
Can you send or receive faxes using etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that etherFAX is set up correctly.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup >
General Fax Settings.
b Make sure that you have the correct fax number.
c Make sure that Fax Transport is set to etherFAX.
Notes:
This menu shows up only when more than one fax
transport is available.
If the printer only has etherFAX installed, then it is
automatically configured.
Can you send or receive faxes using etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Split large documents into smaller file sizes.
Can you send or receive faxes using etherFAX?
The problem is
solved.
Go to
https://www.etherfa
x.net/lexmark.
Troubleshoot a problem 297
background
Poor fax print quality
Action Yes No
Step 1
Make sure that there are no print quality defects.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Troubleshooting >
Print Quality Test Pages.
b Correct any print quality defects. For more information, see
“Print quality is poor” on page 247.
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
If you are using an analog fax, then decrease the incoming fax
transmission speed.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Fax > Fax Setup > Fax
Receive Settings > Admin Controls.
b In the Max Speed menu, select a lower transmission speed.
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Contact customer
support.
Missing information on the fax cover page
Action No Yes
a Turn
o
the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on
the printer.
b Send or retrieve the fax.
Is there missing information on the fax cover page?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot send the fax cover page from the computer
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure that the print driver is updated. For more information,
see
“Installing the printer software” on page 54.
b Send the fax.
Can you send the fax cover page?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 298
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a From the document that you are trying to fax, open the Print
dialog.
b Select the printer, and then click Properties, Preferences,
Options, or Setup.
c Click Fax, and then clear the Always display settings prior to
faxing setting.
d Send the fax.
Can you send the fax cover page?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Scanning problems
Cannot scan to a computer
Action Yes No
Step 1
Perform a copy job.
Is the copy job successful?
Go to step 3. Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn it
back on.
b Scan the document.
Can you scan the document to a computer?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
Check the printer connectivity.
a Print the Network Setup Page. From the home screen, touch
Settings > Reports > Network > Network Setup Page.
b Check the network status.
Is the printer connected to the network?
Go to step 5. Go to step 4.
Step 4
a Connect the printer to the network.
b Scan the document.
Can you scan the document to a computer?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Troubleshoot a problem 299
background
Action Yes No
Step 5
a Make sure that the printer and the computer are connected to
the same network.
b Scan the document.
Can you scan the document to a computer?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Cannot scan to a network folder
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Create a network folder shortcut.
b Scan a document using the shortcut. For more information, see
“Scanning to a network folder” on page 91.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
Make sure that the network folder path and format are correct. For
example, //server_hostname/foldername/path, where
server_hostname is a fully qualified domain (FQDN) or IP
address.
Is the network folder path and format correct?
Go to step 3. Go to step 4.
Step 3
Make sure that you have a write access permission to the network
folder.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 4.
Troubleshoot a problem 300
background
Action Yes No
Step 4
Update the network folder shortcut.
a Open a web browser, and then type the printer IP address in
the address field.
Notes:
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP
address appears as four sets of numbers separated by
periods, such as 123.123.123.123.
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it
to load the web page correctly.
b Click Shortcuts, and then select a shortcut.
Note: If you have multiple shortcut types, then select
Network Folder.
c In the Share Path field, type the network folder path.
Notes:
If your share path is \\server_hostname
\foldername\path, then
type //server_hostname/foldername/path.
Make sure that you use forward slashes when typing the
share path.
d From the Authentication menu, select your authentication
method.
Note: If Authentication is set to “Use assigned username and
password,” then in the User Name and Password fields, type
your credentials.
e Click Save.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 5.
Step 5
Make sure that the printer and the network folder are connected
to the same network.
Can you scan a document and save it to a network folder?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Partial copies of document or photo
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Make sure that the document or photo is loaded facedown on
the upper left corner of the scanner glass.
b Copy the document or photo.
Is the document or photo copied correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 301
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
a Match the paper size setting and the paper loaded in the tray.
b Copy the document or photo.
Is the document or photo copied correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Poor copy quality
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Clean the scanner glass and the ADF glass with a damp, soft,
lintfree cloth. If your printer has a second ADF glass inside the
ADF, then also clean that glass.
For more information, see
“Cleaning the scanner” on page
230.
b Make sure that the document or photo is loaded facedown on
the upper left corner of the scanner glass.
c Copy the document or photo.
Is the copy quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check the quality of the original document or photo.
b Adjust the scan quality settings.
c Copy the document or photo.
Is the copy quality satisfactory?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Vertical dark streaks on output when scanning from the ADF
Troubleshoot a problem 302
background
Action Yes No
a Open the scanner cover.
b Using a damp, soft, lintfree cloth, wipe the ADF glass and the
ADF glass pad.
c Close the scanner cover.
d Scan the document.
Do vertical streaks appear on scanned documents?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Jagged image or text when scanning from the ADF
Action Yes No
a Load 50 sheets of clean, plain paper into the ADF.
Note: The plain paper helps clean or remove dust and other
coating from the ADF feed rollers.
b From the home screen, touch
.
c Load an original document into the ADF.
d Scan the document.
Do jagged images or texts appear on the output?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Scan job was not successful
Action Yes No
Step 1
Check the cable connections.
a Make sure that the Ethernet or USB cable is securely connected
to the computer and the printer.
b Scan the document.
Is the scan job successful?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Troubleshoot a problem 303
background
Action Yes No
Step 2
Check the file that you want to scan.
a Make sure that the file name is not already used in the
destination folder.
b Make sure that the document or photo you want to scan is not
open in another application.
c Scan the document.
Is the scan job successful?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Make sure that the Append time stamp or the Overwrite
existing file check box is selected in the destination
configuration settings.
b Scan the document.
Is the scan job successful?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Scanner does not close
Action Yes No
Remove obstructions that keep the scanner cover open.
Did the scanner cover close correctly?
The problem is
solved.
Contact customer
support.
Scanning takes too long or freezes the computer
Action Yes No
Close all applications that are interfering with the scan.
Does scanning take too long or freeze the computer?
Contact customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Troubleshoot a problem 304
background
Scanner does not respond
Action Yes No
Step 1
a Check if the power cord is connected properly to the printer
and the electrical outlet.
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To avoid the risk of
fire
or electrical shock, connect the power cord to an
appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet
that is near the product and easily accessible.
b Copy or scan the document.
Is the scanner responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 2.
Step 2
a Check if the printer is turned on.
b Resolve any error messages that appear on the display.
c Copy or scan the document.
Is the scanner responding?
The problem is
solved.
Go to step 3.
Step 3
a Turn o the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the
printer on.
b Copy or scan the document.
Is the scanner responding?
The problem is
solved.
Contact
customer
support.
Adjusting scanner registration
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Configuration Menu > Scanner
Configuration > Scanner Manual Registration.
2 In the Print Quick Test menu, touch Start.
3 Place the Print Quick Test page on the scanner glass, and then touch Flatbed Registration.
4 In the Copy Quick Test menu, touch Start.
5 Compare the Copy Quick Test page with the original document.
Note: If the margins of the test page are
dierent
from the original document, then adjust Left Margin and
Top Margin.
6 Repeat step 4 and step 5 until the margins of the Copy Quick Test page closely match the original document.
Adjusting ADF registration
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Device > Maintenance > Configuration Menu > Scanner
Configuration > Scanner Manual Registration.
2 In the Print Quick Test menu, touch Start.
Troubleshoot a problem 305
background
3 Place the Print Quick Test page on the ADF tray.
4 Tou ch Front ADF Registration or Rear ADF Registration.
Notes:
To align Front ADF Registration, place the test page faceup, short edge
first
into the ADF.
To align Rear ADF Registration, place the test page facedown, short edge
first
into the ADF.
5 In the Copy Quick Test menu, touch Start.
6 Compare the Copy Quick Test page with the original document.
Note: If the margins of the test page are
dierent
from the original document, then adjust Horizontal
Adjust and Top Margin.
7 Repeat
step 5 and step 6 until the margins of the Copy Quick Test page closely match the original document.
Color quality problems
Modifying the colors in printed output
1 From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality > Advanced Imaging > Color Correction.
2 In the Color Correction menu, touch Manual > Color Correction Content.
3 Choose the appropriate color conversion setting.
Object type Color conversion tables
RGB Image
RGB Text
RGB Graphics
Vivid—Produces brighter, more saturated colors and may be
applied to all incoming color formats.
sRGB Display—Produces an output that approximates the colors
shown on a computer monitor. Black toner usage is optimized for
printing photographs.
DisplayTrue Black—Produces an output that approximates the
colors shown on a computer monitor. This setting uses only black
toner to create all levels of neutral gray.
sRGB Vivid—Provides an increased color saturation for the sRGB
Display color correction. Black toner usage is optimized for
printing business graphics.
O
CMYK Image
CMYK Text
CMYK Graphics
US CMYK—Applies color correction to approximate the
Specifications for Web Oset Publishing (SWOP) color output.
Euro CMYK—Applies color correction to approximate Euroscale
color output.
Vivid CMYK—Increases the color saturation of the US CMYK color
correction setting.
O
Troubleshoot a problem 306
background
FAQ about color printing
What is RGB color?
RGB color is a method of describing colors by indicating the amount of red, green, or blue used to produce
a certain color. Red, green, and blue light can be added in various amounts to produce a large range of colors
observed in nature. Computer screens, scanners, and digital cameras use this method to display colors.
What is CMYK color?
CMYK color is a method of describing colors by indicating the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow, and black
used to reproduce a particular color. Cyan, magenta, yellow, and black inks or toners can be printed in various
amounts to produce a large range of colors observed in nature. Printing presses, inkjet printers, and color
laser printers create colors in this manner.
How is color specified in a document to be printed?
Software programs are used to specify and modify the document color using RGB or CMYK color
combinations. For more information, see the software program Help topics.
How does the printer know what color to print?
When printing a document, information describing the type and color of each object is sent to the printer and
is passed through color conversion tables. Color is translated into the appropriate amounts of cyan, magenta,
yellow, and black toner used to produce the color you want. The object information determines the application
of color conversion tables. For example, it is possible to apply one type of color conversion table to text while
applying a dierent color conversion table to photographic images.
What is manual color correction?
When manual color correction is enabled, the printer employs userselected color conversion tables to
process objects. Manual color correction settings are specific to the type of object being printed (text,
graphics, or images). It is also specific to how the color of the object is specified in the software program
(RGB or CMYK combinations). To apply a dierent color conversion table manually, see
“Modifying the colors
in printed output” on page 306.
If the software program does not specify colors with RGB or CMYK combinations, then manual color correction
is not useful. It is also not eective if the software program or the computer operating system controls the
adjustment of colors. In most situations, setting the Color Correction to Auto generates preferred colors for
the documents.
How can I match a particular color (such as a corporate logo)?
From the printer Quality menu, nine types of Color Samples sets are available. These sets are also available
from the Color Samples page of the Embedded Web Server. Selecting any sample set generates
multiplepage prints consisting of hundreds of colored boxes. Each box contains a CMYK or RGB combination,
depending on the table selected. The observed color of each box is obtained by passing the CMYK or RGB
combination labeled on the box through the selected color conversion table.
By examining Color Samples sets, you can identify the box with color closest to the color being matched.
The color combination labeled on the box can then be used for modifying the color of the object in a software
program. For more information, see the software program Help topics. Manual color correction may be
necessary to use the selected color conversion table for the particular object.
Selecting which Color Samples set to use for a particular colormatching problem depends on:
The Color Correction setting being used (Auto, O, or Manual)
The type of object being printed (text, graphics, or images)
How the color of the object is specified in the software program (RGB or CMYK combinations)
Troubleshoot a problem 307
background
If the software program does not specify colors with RGB or CMYK combinations, then the Color Samples
pages are not useful. Additionally, some software programs adjust the RGB or CMYK combinations specified
in the program through color management. In these situations, the printed color may not be an exact match
of the Color Samples pages.
The print appears tinted
Action Yes No
Step 1
Perform Color Adjust.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Adjust.
b Print the document.
Does the print appear tinted?
Go to step 2. The problem is
solved.
Step 2
Perform Color Balance.
a From the home screen, touch Settings > Print > Quality >
Advanced Imaging > Color Balance.
b Adjust the settings.
c Print the document.
Does the print appear tinted?
Contact
customer
support.
The problem is
solved.
Contacting customer support
Before contacting customer support, make sure to have the following information:
Printer problem
Error message
Printer model type and serial number
Go to
http://support.lexmark.com to receive email or chat support, or browse through the library of manuals,
support documentation, drivers, and other downloads.
Technical support via telephone is also available. In the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-539-6275. For other countries
or regions, go to
the international support contact directory.
Troubleshoot a problem 308
background
Recycle and dispose
Recycling Lexmark products
To return Lexmark products for recycling:
1 Go to
www.lexmark.com/recycle.
2 Select your country or region.
3 Select a recycling program.
4 Follow the instructions on the screen.
Recycling Lexmark packaging
Lexmark continually strives to minimize packaging. Less packaging helps to ensure that Lexmark printers are
transported in the most
ecient
and environmentally sensitive manner and that there is less packaging to
dispose of. These eciencies result in fewer greenhouse emissions, energy savings, and natural resource
savings. Lexmark also oers recycling of packaging components in some countries or regions. For more
information, go to www.lexmark.com/recycle, and then choose your country or region. Information on available
packaging recycling programs is included with the information on product recycling.
Lexmark cartons are 100% recyclable where corrugated recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist in your
area.
The foam used in Lexmark packaging is recyclable where foam recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist
in your area.
When you return a cartridge to Lexmark, you can reuse the box that the cartridge came in. Lexmark recycles
the box.
Recycle and dispose 309
background
Notices
Product information
Product name:
Lexmark CX532adwe, Lexmark CX635adwe, Lexmark XC2335 MFPs
Machine type:
7531
Models:
276, 286, 289, 676, 686
Edition notice
April 2023
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local
law: LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC., PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of
express or implied warranties in certain transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made
to the information herein; these changes will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the
products or the programs described may be made at any time.
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to
make these available in all countries in which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is
not intended to state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be used. Any functionally
equivalent product, program, or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be
used instead. Evaluation and
verification
of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services,
except those expressly designated by the manufacturer, are the user’s responsibility.
For Lexmark technical support, go to
http://support.lexmark.com.
For information on Lexmark's privacy policy governing the use of this product, go to
www.lexmark.com/privacy.
For information on supplies and downloads, go to
www.lexmark.com.
© 2023 Lexmark International, Inc.
All rights reserved.
GOVERNMENT END USERS
The Software Program and any related documentation are "Commercial Items," as that term is
defined
in 48
C.F.R. 2.101, "Computer Software" and "Commercial Computer Software Documentation," as such terms are
used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 or 48 C.F.R. 227.7202, as applicable. Consistent with 48 C.F.R. 12.212 or 48 C.F.R.
227.7202-1 through 227.7207-4, as applicable, the Commercial Computer Software and Commercial Software
Notices 310
background
Documentation are licensed to the U.S. Government end users (a) only as Commercial Items and (b) with only
those rights as are granted to all other end users pursuant to the terms and conditions herein.
Trademarks
Lexmark, the Lexmark logo, and MarkNet are trademarks or registered trademarks of Lexmark International,
Inc. in the United States and/or other countries.
Gmail, Android, Google Play, and Google Chrome are trademarks of Google LLC.
Macintosh, macOS, Safari, and AirPrint are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
App Store and iCloud are service marks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Use of the
Works with Apple badge means that an accessory has been designed to work specifically with the technology
identified in the badge and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards.
Microsoft, Internet Explorer, Microsoft 365, Microsoft Edge, Outlook, and Windows are trademarks of the
Microsoft group of companies.
The Mopria® word mark is a registered and/or unregistered trademark of Mopria Alliance, Inc. in the United
States and other countries. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited.
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard Company. PCL is Hewlett-Packard Company’s
designation of a set of printer commands (language) and functions included in its printer products. This printer
is intended to be compatible with the PCL language. This means the printer recognizes PCL commands used
in various application programs, and that the printer emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.
Wi-Fi® and Wi-Fi Direct® are registered trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance®.
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Licensing notices
All licensing notices associated with this product can be viewed from the CD:\NOTICES directory of the
installation software CD.
Noise emission levels
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in conformance with ISO
9296.
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA
Printing One-sided: 50 (CX532, XC2335); 53
(CX635)
Two-sided: 52 (CX532, XC2335); 54
(CX635)
Scanning 51
Copying 54 (CX532, XC2335); 55 (CX635)
Notices 311
background
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA
Ready 14
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.
Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) directive
The WEEE logo
signifies
specific
recycling programs and procedures for electronic products in countries of the
European Union. We encourage the recycling of our products.
If you have further questions about recycling options, visit the Lexmark Web site at
www.lexmark.com for your
local sales oce phone number.
India E-Waste notice
This product including components, consumables, parts and spares complies with the “India E-Waste Rules”
and prohibits use of lead, mercury, hexavalent chromium, polybrominated biphenyls or polybrominated
diphenyl ethers in concentrations exceeding 0.1% by weight and 0.01% by weight for cadmium, except for the
exemption set in the Rule.
Lithium
ion rechargeable battery
Notices 312
background
This product may contain a coin-cell, lithium-ion rechargeable battery, which should only be removed by a
trained technician. Crossed-out wheelie bin means the product should not be discarded as unsorted waste but
must be sent to separate collection facilities for recovery and recycling. In the event the battery is removed, do
not dispose of the battery in your household waste. There may be separate collection systems for batteries in
your local community, such as a battery-recycling drop-o location. The separate collection of waste batteries
assures appropriate treatment of waste including reuse and recycling and prevents any potential negative
eects on human health and environment. Please responsibly dispose of the batteries.
Product disposal
Do not dispose of the printer or supplies in the same manner as normal household waste. Consult your local
authorities for disposal and recycling options.
Returning Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling
The Lexmark Cartridge Collection Program allows you to return used cartridges for free to Lexmark for reuse
or recycling. One hundred percent of the empty cartridges returned to Lexmark are either reused or
demanufactured for recycling. The boxes used to return the cartridges are also recycled.
To return Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling, do the following:
1 Go to
www.lexmark.com/recycle.
2 Select your country or region.
3 Select Lexmark Cartridge Collection Program.
4 Follow the instructions on the screen.
Static sensitivity notice
This symbol identifies static-sensitive parts. Do not touch the areas near these symbols without first touching
a metal surface in an area away from the symbol.
To prevent damage from electrostatic discharge when performing maintenance tasks such as clearing paper
jams or replacing supplies, touch any exposed metal frame of the printer before accessing or touching interior
areas of the printer even if the symbol is not present.
Notices 313
background
ENERGY STAR
Any Lexmark product bearing the ENERGY STAR
®
emblem on the product or on a start-up screen is
certified
to
comply with Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) ENERGY STAR requirements as of the date of manufacture.
Temperature information
Operating temperature and relative humidity 10 to 32.2°C (50 to 90°F) and 15 to 80% RH
15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F) and 8 to 80% RH
Maximum wet-bulb temperature
2
: 22.8°C (73°F)
Non-condensing environment
Printer / cartridge / imaging unit long-
term storage
1
15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F) and 8 to 80% RH
Maximum wet-bulb temperature
2
: 22.8°C (73°F)
Printer / cartridge / imaging unit short-term
shipping
-40 to 40°C (-40 to 104°F)
1
Supplies shelf life is approximately 2 years. This is based on storage in a standard oce environment at 22°C (72°F)
and 45% humidity.
2
Wet-bulb temperature is determined by the air temperature and the relative humidity.
Laser notice
The printer is
certified
in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, Chapter I, Subchapter J for
Class I (1) laser products, and elsewhere is
certified
as a Class 1 consumer laser product conforming to the
requirements of IEC 60825-1:2014, EN 60825-1:2014+A11:2021, and EN 50689:2021.
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and printer are designed so there
is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance,
or prescribed service conditions. The printer has a non-serviceable printhead assembly that contains a laser
with the following
specifications:
Class: IIIb (3b) AlGaAs
Nominal output power (milliwatts): 12
Wavelength (nanometers): 770–800
Notices 314
background
Power consumption
Product power consumption
The following table documents the power consumption characteristics of the product.
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.
Mode Description Power consumption (Watts)
Printing The product is generating hardcopy output from electronic
inputs.
One-sided: 518 (CX532, XC2335);
587 (CX635)
Two-sided: 366 (CX532, XC2335);
402 (CX635)
Copy The product is generating hardcopy output from hardcopy
original documents.
549 (CX532, XC2335); 606 (CX635)
Scan The product is scanning hardcopy documents. 37.1
Ready The product is waiting for a print job. 25.5 (CX532, XC2335); 29 (CX635)
Sleep Mode The product is in a highlevel energysaving mode. 1.3
Hibernate The product is in a lowlevel energysaving mode. 0.2
O The product is plugged into an electrical outlet, but the power
switch is turned o.
0.2
The power consumption levels listed in the previous table represent time-averaged measurements.
Instantaneous power draws may be substantially higher than the average.
Values are subject to change. See
www.lexmark.com for current values.
Sleep Mode
This product is designed with an energy-saving mode called Sleep Mode. The Sleep Mode saves energy by
lowering power consumption during extended periods of inactivity. The Sleep Mode is automatically engaged
after this product is not used for a
specified
period of time, called the Sleep Mode Timeout.
Factory default Sleep Mode Timeout for this product (in minutes): 15
By using the configuration menus, the Sleep Mode Timeout can be modified between 1 minute and 120 minutes,
or between 1 minute and 114 minutes, depending on the printer model. If the printer speed is less than or equal
to 30 pages per minute, then you can set the timeout only up to 60 minutes or 54 minutes, depending on the
printer model. Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a low value reduces energy consumption, but may increase
the response time of the product. Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a high value maintains a fast response,
but uses more energy.
Some models support a Deep Sleep Mode, which further reduces power consumption after longer periods of
inactivity.
Notices 315
background
Hibernate Mode
This product is designed with an ultralow power operating mode called Hibernate mode. When operating in
Hibernate Mode, all other systems and devices are powered down safely.
The Hibernate mode can be entered in any of the following methods:
Using the Hibernate Timeout
Using the Schedule Power modes
Factory default Hibernate Timeout for this product in all countries or regions 3 days
The amount of time the printer waits after a job is printed before it enters Hibernate mode can be modified
between one hour and one month.
Notes on EPEAT-registered imaging equipment products:
Standby power level occurs in Hibernate or
O
mode.
The product shall automatically power down to a standby power level of ≤ 1 W. The auto standby function
(Hibernate or O) shall be enabled at product shipment.
O
mode
If this product has an o mode which still consumes a small amount of power, then to completely stop product
power consumption, disconnect the power supply cord from the electrical outlet.
Total energy usage
It is sometimes helpful to estimate the total product energy usage. Since power consumption claims are
provided in power units of Watts, the power consumption should be multiplied by the time the product spends
in each mode in order to calculate energy usage. The total product energy usage is the sum of each mode's
energy usage.
Applicability of Regulation (EU) 2019/2015 and (EU) 2019/2020
Per Commission Regulation (EU) 2019/2015 and (EU) 2019/2020, the light source contained within this product
or its component is intended to be used for Image Capture or Image Projection only, and is not intended for
use in other applications.
Thailand NBTC technical standards conformity statement
คําประกาศเรื่องการเปนไปตามมาตรฐานทางเทคนคของ
กสทช
.
ประเทศไทย
This telecommunication equipment conforms to the technical standards or requirements of NBTC.
เครื่องโทรคมนาคมและอปกรน
มีความสอดคลองตามมาตรฐานหรอขอก
าหนดทางเทคนคของ กสทช.
Regulatory notices for telecommunication terminal equipment
This section contains regulatory information pertaining to products that contain the analog facsimile card:
Lexmark Regulatory Type/Model Number:
Notices 316
background
LEX-M03-002
Notice to users of the US telephone network: FCC requirements
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the Administrative
Council for Terminal Attachments (ACTA). On the back of this equipment is a label that contains, among other
information, a product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided
to your telephone company.
This equipment uses the RJ-11C Universal Service Order Code (USOC) jack.
A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises’ wiring and telephone network must comply
with the applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. Use a compliant telephone cord
(RJ-11) that is 26 AWG or larger when connecting this product to the public switched telephone network. See
your setup documentation for more information.
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to
a telephone line. Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an
incoming call. In most but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number
of devices that may be connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact your local telephone
company. For products approved after July 23, 2001, the REN for this product is part of the product
identifier
that has the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. The digits represented by ## are the REN without a decimal point
(for example, 03 is a REN of 0.3). For earlier products, the REN is shown separately on the label.
If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that
temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If advance notice is not practical, the telephone company
will notify the customer as soon as possible. You will also be advised of your right to
file
a complaint with the
FCC.
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations or procedures that could
aect the operation of this equipment. If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in
order for you to make necessary
modifications
to maintain uninterrupted service.
If you experience trouble with this equipment, for repair or warranty information, contact Lexmark International,
Inc. at
www.lexmark.com or your Lexmark representative. If the equipment is causing harm to the telephone
network, the telephone company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is resolved.
This equipment contains no user serviceable parts. For repair and warranty information, contact Lexmark
International, Inc. See the previous paragraph for contact information.
Connection to party line service is subject to state taris. Contact the state public utility commission, public
service commission, or corporation commission for information.
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line, ensure the installation of
this equipment does not disable your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable alarm
equipment, consult your telephone company or a
qualified
installer.
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other
electronic device, including fax machines, to send any message unless said message clearly contains in a
margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission, the date and time
it is sent and an
identification
of the business or other entity, or other individual sending the message, and the
telephone number of the sending machine or such business, other entity, or individual. (The telephone number
provided may not be a 900 number or any other number for which charges exceed local or long-distance
transmission charges.)
See your user documentation in order to program this information into your fax machine.
Notices 317
background
Notice to users of the Canadian telephone network
This product meets the applicable Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada technical
specifications.
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) indicates the maximum number of devices allowed to be connected to
a telephone interface. The termination of an interface may consist of any combination of devices subject only
to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of all the devices not exceed five. The REN is located on the product
label.
This equipment uses CA11A telephone jacks.
Avis réservé aux utilisateurs du réseau téléphonique du Canada
Ce produit est conforme aux spécifications techniques d’Innovation, Sciences et Développement économique
Canada.
Le numéro REN (ringer equivalence number : numéro d’équivalence de sonnerie) indique le nombre maximum
d'appareils pouvant être connectés à l’interface téléphonique. En bout de ligne, le nombre d’appareils qui
peuvent être connectés n’est pas directement limité, mais la somme des REN de ces appareils ne doit pas
dépasser cinq. Le numéro REN est indiqué sur l'étiquette produit.
Cet équipement utilise des prises de téléphone CA11A.
Notice to users of the New Zealand telephone network
The following are special conditions for the Facsimile User Instructions. The grant of a telepermit for any item
of terminal equipment indicates only that Spark has accepted that the item complies with minimum conditions
for connection to its network. It indicates no endorsement of the product by Spark, nor does it provide any sort
of warranty. Above all, it provides no assurance that any item will work correctly in all respects with another
item of telepermitted equipment of a dierent make or model, nor does it imply that any product is compatible
with all of Spark's network services.
This equipment shall not be set up to make automatic calls to the Spark “111” Emergency Service.
This equipment may not provide for the eective hand-over of a call to another device connected to the same
line.
This equipment should not be used under any circumstances that may constitute a nuisance to other Spark
customers.
This equipment is not capable, under all operating conditions, of correct operation at the higher speeds for
which it is designed. Spark will accept no responsibility should diculties arise in such circumstances.
The decadic (or pulse) dialing on this device is unsuitable for use on the Spark network in New Zealand.
For correct operation, the total of all the Ringer Equivalence Numbers (RENs) of all parallel devices connected
to the same telephone line may not exceed 5. The REN of this device is located on the label.
This device uses an RJ-11C modular connector. Contact your point of purchase if a BT adapter is required. The
Lexmark part number is 80D1873.
Notices 318
background
Some parameters required for compliance with Spark's telepermit requirements are dependent on the
equipment associated with this device. The associated equipment shall be set to operate within the following
limits for compliance to Spark's specifications:
There shall be no more than 10 call attempts to the same number within any 30 minute period for any single
manual call initiation, and
The equipment shall go on-hook for a period of not less than 30 seconds between the end of one attempt
and the beginning of the next call attempt.
The equipment shall be set to ensure that automatic calls to
dierent
numbers are spaced such that there
is not less than 5 seconds between the end of one call attempt and the beginning of another.
Japanese telecom notice
The installed optional modem is in compliance with Japanese Telecommunication Law and has been Certified
by JATE, with the following Certification Number:
A18-0046001 or A11-0160001JP
Lexmark International, Inc.
LEX-M03-002
A18-0046001 or A11-0160001JP
Using this product in Switzerland
This product requires a Swiss billing tone filter (Lexmark part number 80D1877) to be installed on any line which
receives metering pulses in Switzerland.
Utilisation de ce produit en Suisse
Cet appareil nécessite l’utilisation d’un filtre de tonalité de facturation suisse (nº de référence Lexmark :
80D1877) devant être installé sur toute ligne recevant des impulsions de comptage en Suisse.
Verwendung dieses Produkts in der Schweiz
Für dieses Produkt muss ein schweizerischer Billing Tone Filter zur Zählzeichenübertragung (Lexmark
Teilenummer 80D1877) für jede Leitung installiert werden, über die in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte übertragen
werden.
Uso del prodotto in Svizzera
Questo prodotto richiede un filtro toni Billing svizzero, (codice Lexmark 80D1877) da installare su tutte le linee
che ricevono impulsi remoti in Svizzera.
Notices 319
background
Regulatory notices for wireless products
This section contains regulatory information that applies only to wireless models.
If in doubt as to whether your model is a wireless model, then see
“Wireless support” on page 68.
Modular component notice
Wireless models contain the following modular component:
AzureWave AW-CM467-SUR; FCC ID:TLZ-CM467; IC:6100A-CM467
To determine which modular components are installed in your particular product, refer to the labeling on your
actual product.
Exposure to radio frequency radiation
The radiated output power of this device is far below the radio frequency exposure limits of the FCC and other
regulatory agencies. A minimum separation of 20 cm (8 inches) must be maintained between the antenna and
any persons for this device to satisfy the RF exposure requirements of the FCC and other regulatory agencies.
Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada
This device complies with Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada license-exempt RSS
standards. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the
device.
Innovation, Sciences et Développement économique Canada
Cet appareil est conforme aux normes RSS exemptes de licence d'Innovation, Sciences et Développement
économique Canada. Son fonctionnement est soumis aux deux conditions suivantes : (1) cet appareil ne doit
pas causer d'interférences et (2) il doit accepter toutes les interférences, y compris les celles qui peuvent
entraîner un fonctionnement indésirable.
European Community (EC) directives conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directive 2014/53/EU on the
approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to radio equipment.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The EEA/EU authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8
Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. The EEA/EU Importer is: Lexmark
International Technology S.à.r.l. 20, Route de Pré-Bois, ICC Building, Bloc A, CH-1215 Genève, Switzerland. A
declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon request from the Authorized
Representative or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/european-union-declaration-of-conformity.html.
Notices 320
background
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking:
Restrictions
This radio equipment is restricted to indoor use only. Outdoor use is prohibited. This restriction applies to all
the countries listed in the table below:
AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE
EL ES FI FR HR HU IE IS IT
LI LT LU LV MT NL NO PL PT
RO SE SI SK TR UK (NI)
EU and other countries statement of radio transmitter operational frequency bands and
maximum RF power
This radio product transmits in either the 2.4GHz (2.412–2.472 GHz in the EU) or 5GHz (5.15–5.35, 5.47–5.725
in the EU) bands. The maximum transmitter EIRP power output, including antenna gain, is ≤ 20dBm for both
bands.
United Kingdom (UK) conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of the Radio Equipment Regulations 2017.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The UK Importer is: Lexmark International Ltd,
Highfield
House, Foundation Park - 8 Roxborough
Way, Maidenhead Berkshire - SL6 3UD, United Kingdom. A declaration of conformity is available upon request
from the UK Importer or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/uk-declaration-of-conformity.html.
Compliance is indicated by the UKCA marking:
Notices 321
background
Restrictions or requirements in the UK
This radio equipment is restricted to indoor use only. Outdoor use is prohibited.
UK statement of radio transmitter operational frequency bands and maximum RF power
This radio product transmits in either the 2.4GHz (2.412–2.472 GHz in the UK) or 5GHz (5.15–5.35, 5.47–5.725
in the UK) bands. The maximum transmitter EIRP power output, including antenna gain, is ≤ 20dBm for both
bands.
Notice to users in Thailand
ประกาศถงผ
ใชในประเทศไทย
This radiocommunication equipment has the electromagnetic field strength in compliance with the Safety
Standard for the Use of Radiocommunication Equipment on Human Health announced by the National
Telecommunications Commission.
เครื่องวทยคมนาคมน
มีระดบการแผ
คลื่นแม
เหลกไฟฟาสอดคลองตามมาตรฐาน ความปลอดภยต
อสขภาพของมนษยจากการใชเครื่องวทยคมนาคมที่คณะกรรมการก
จการ
โทรคมนาคมแห
งชาตประกาศก
าหนด
Modelspecific information
The following information applies only to the CX635 (7531-686, 7531-676) printer model.
Notices 322
background
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information
statement
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part
15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the
equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful
interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful
interference, in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by using other than
recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or
modifications
to this equipment. Unauthorized changes
or modifications could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class A computing
device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach
or 1021294 for USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a
violation of FCC regulations.
Any questions regarding this compliance information statement should be directed to:
Director of Lexmark Technology & Services
Lexmark International, Inc.
740 West New Circle Road
Lexington, KY 40550
Telephone: (859) 232–2000
Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada compliance
statement
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment
Standard ICES-003.
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’Innovation, Sciences et
Développement économique Canada
Cet appareil numérique de classe A est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux
équipements pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.
Notices 323
background
Japanese VCCI notice
Notice to users of Class A products in Brazil
Este produto não é apropriado para uso em ambientes domésticos, pois poderá causar interferências
eletromagnéticas que obrigam o usuário a tomar medidas necessárias para minimizar estas interferências.
European Community (EC) directives conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2014/30/EU, 2014/35/EU,
and 2011/65/EU as amended by (EU) 2015/863 on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the
Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within
certain voltage limits, and on the restrictions of use of certain hazardous substances in electrical and electronic
equipment.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The EEA/EU authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8
Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. The EEA/EU Importer is: Lexmark
International Technology S.à.r.l. 20, Route de Pré-Bois, ICC Building, Bloc A, CH-1215 Genève, Switzerland. A
declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon request from the Authorized
Representative or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/european-union-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55032 and safety requirements of EN 62368-1.
United Kingdom (UK) conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of the Electromagnetic Compatibility Regulations
2016, the Electrical Equipment (Safety) Regulations 2016, and the Restriction of the Use of Certain Hazardous
Substances in Electrical and Electronic Equipment Regulations 2012.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The UK Importer is: Lexmark International Ltd, Highfield House, Foundation Park - 8 Roxborough
Way, Maidenhead Berkshire - SL6 3UD, United Kingdom. A declaration of conformity is available upon request
from the UK Importer or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/uk-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class A limits of BS EN 55032 and safety requirements of BS EN 62368-1.
Notices 324
background
Radio interference notice
Warning
This is a product that complies with the emission requirements of EN 55032 Class A limits and immunity
requirements of EN 55035. This product is not intended to be used in residential/domestic environments.
This is a Class A product. In a domestic environment, this product may cause radio interference, in which case
the user may be required to take adequate measures.
Multiple model information
The following information applies to the CX532 (7531-286, 7531-276) and XC2335 (7531-289) printer models.
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information
statement
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part
15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
The FCC Class B limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the
equipment is operated in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful
interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a
particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which
can be determined by turning the equipment o and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference
by one or more of the following measures:
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit dierent from that to which the receiver is connected.
Consult your point of purchase or service representative for additional suggestions.
The manufacturer is not responsible for radio or television interference caused by using other than
recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment. Unauthorized changes
or modifications could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class B computing
device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach
or 1021294 for USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a
violation of FCC regulations.
Any questions regarding this compliance information statement should be directed to:
Director of Lexmark Technology & Services
Lexmark International, Inc.
740 West New Circle Road
Lexington, KY 40550
Telephone: (859) 232–2000
Notices 325
background
Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada compliance
statement
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment
Standard ICES-003.
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’Innovation, Sciences et
Développement économique Canada
Cet appareil numérique de classe B est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux
équipements pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.
日本
VCCI
規定
製品にこのマークが表示されている
場合
、次の要件を満たしています。
この装置
、クラス B 情報技術装置
です
。この装置
、家庭環境で使用することを目的としていますが、この
装置がラジオやテレビジョン受信機に近接して
使用されると
、受信障害を引き起こすことがあります。
取扱説明書に従って正しい取り扱いをしてください。
VCCI-B
European Community (EC) directives conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2014/30/EU, 2014/35/EU,
2009/125/EC, and 2011/65/EU as amended by (EU) 2015/863 on the approximation and harmonization of the
laws of the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed
for use within certain voltage limits, the ecodesign of energy-related products, and on the restrictions of use of
certain hazardous substances in electrical and electronic equipment.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The EEA/EU authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8
Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. The EEA/EU Importer is: Lexmark
International Technology S.à.r.l. 20, Route de Pré-Bois, ICC Building, Bloc A, CH-1215 Genève, Switzerland. A
declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon request from the Authorized
Representative or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/european-union-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class B limits of EN 55032 and safety requirements of EN 62368-1.
Notices 326
background
United Kingdom (UK) conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of the Electromagnetic Compatibility Regulations
2016, the Electrical Equipment (Safety) Regulations 2016, the Ecodesign for Energy-Related Products and
Energy Information (Amendment) (EU Exit) Regulations 2019, and the Restriction of the Use of Certain Hazardous
Substances in Electrical and Electronic Equipment Regulations 2012.
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY,
40550 USA. The UK Importer is: Lexmark International Ltd,
Highfield
House, Foundation Park - 8 Roxborough
Way, Maidenhead Berkshire - SL6 3UD, United Kingdom. A declaration of conformity is available upon request
from the UK Importer or may be obtained at
www.lexmark.com/en_us/about/regulatory-compliance/uk-declaration-of-conformity.html.
This product satisfies the Class B limits of BS EN 55032 and safety requirements of BS EN 62368-1.
STATEMENT OF LIMITED WARRANTY FOR LEXMARK LASER PRINTERS,
LEXMARK LED PRINTERS, AND LEXMARK MULTIFUNCTION LASER
PRINTERS
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY
This limited warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S., refer to the
country-specific
warranty information that came with your product.
This limited warranty applies to this product only if it was originally purchased for your use, and not for resale,
from Lexmark or a Lexmark Remarketer, referred to in this statement as “Remarketer.
Limited warranty
Lexmark warrants that this product:
—Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which perform like new parts
—Is, during normal use, free from defects in material and workmanship
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a Remarketer or Lexmark for
repair or replacement (at Lexmark's option).
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or option is used with the
product for which it was intended. To obtain warranty service, you may be required to present the feature or
option with the product.
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this statement is available to
that user for the remainder of the warranty period. You should transfer proof of original purchase and this
statement to that user.
Limited warranty service
The warranty period starts on the date of original purchase as shown on the purchase receipt and ends 12
months later provided that the warranty period for any supplies and for any maintenance items included with
the printer shall end earlier if it, or its original contents, are substantially used up, depleted, or consumed. Fuser
Units, Transfer/Transport Units, Paper Feed items, if any, and any other items for which a Maintenance Kit is
Notices 327
background
available are substantially consumed when the printer displays a “Life Warning” or “Scheduled Maintenance”
message for such item.
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase. You may be required to
deliver your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark
designated location. You are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the
Lexmark designated location.
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced becomes the property of
the Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or repaired item.
The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the original product.
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced, altered, in need of a
repair not included in warranty service, damaged beyond repair, or if the product is not free of all legal
obligations, restrictions, liens, and encumbrances.
As part of your warranty service and/or replacement, Lexmark may update the firmware in your printer to the
latest version. Firmware updates may modify printer settings and cause counterfeit and/or unauthorized
products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces to stop working. Authorized
use of genuine Lexmark products will not be impacted.
Before you present this product for warranty service, remove all print cartridges, programs, data, and removable
storage media (unless directed otherwise by Lexmark).
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark authorized servicer in your area
contact Lexmark on the World Wide Web.
Remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty period. For products no longer
covered by a Lexmark warranty, technical support may not be available or only be available for a fee.
Extent of limited warranty
Lexmark does not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of any product or the durability or longevity of
prints produced by any product.
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:
—Modification or unauthorized attachments
—Accidents, misuse, abuse or use inconsistent with Lexmark user’s guides, manuals, instructions or guidance
—Unsuitable physical or operating environment
—Maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer
—Operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle
—Use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications
—Refurbishment, repair,
refilling
or remanufacture by a third party of products, supplies or parts
—Products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces not furnished by Lexmark
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER LEXMARK NOR ITS THIRD PARTY SUPPLIERS
OR REMARKETERS MAKE ANY OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED, WITH RESPECT TO THIS PRODUCT, AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND
SATISFACTORY QUALITY. ANY WARRANTIES THAT MAY NOT BE DISCLAIMED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW
ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL
Notices 328
background
APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD. ALL INFORMATION, SPECIFICATIONS, PRICES, AND SERVICES ARE SUBJECT
TO CHANGE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT NOTICE.
Limitation of liability
Your sole remedy under this limited warranty is set forth in this document. For any claim concerning performance
or nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer for this product under this limited warranty, you may recover
actual damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the amount you paid for the
product that caused the damages. This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or
damage to real property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. IN NO EVENT WILL
LEXMARK BE LIABLE FOR ANY LOST PROFITS, LOST SAVINGS, INCIDENTAL DAMAGE, OR OTHER
ECONOMIC OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES. This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a Remarketer of the
possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any claim by you based on a third party claim.
This limitation of remedies also applies to claims against any Suppliers and Remarketers of Lexmark. Lexmark's
and its Suppliers' and Remarketers' limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such Suppliers and Remarketers
are intended beneficiaries of this limitation.
Additional rights
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not allow the exclusion or
limitation of incidental or consequential damages, so the limitations or exclusions contained above may not
apply to you.
This limited warranty gives you
specific
legal rights. You may also have other rights that vary from state to state.
Notices 329
background
Index
A
activating Voice Guidance 30
adding a shortcut
copy 83
adding apps to home screen 25
adding contact groups 29
adding contacts 29
adding hardware options
print driver 56
adding internal options
print driver 56
adding printers to a computer 54
adding shortcut
email 84
fax destination 86
FTP address 91
Address Book
using 29
ADF pick roller
cleaning 233
replacing 215
ADF registration
adjusting 305
ADF rollers
cleaning 233
replacing 215
ADF separator roller
cleaning 233
replacing 215
adjusting
scanner registration 305
adjusting ADF registration 305
adjusting brightness
of display 237
adjusting default volume
headphone 32
speaker 32
adjusting fax darkness 87
adjusting speech rate
Voice Guidance 32
adjusting toner darkness 80
AirPrint
using 76
analog fax
setting up 33
answering machine
setting up 35
assigning printer to a ring
pattern 39
attaching cables 23
avoiding paper jams 275
B
black images 259
blank pages 247
blocking junk faxes 87
bookmarks
creating 28
creating folders for 29
C
caller ID is not shown 293
canceling a print job 80
cannot connect printer to
WiFi 286
cannot detect internal
option 287
cannot open Embedded Web
Server 284
cannot receive faxes using
analog fax 296
cannot scan to a computer 299
cannot scan to a network
folder 300
cannot send emails 293
cannot send or receive faxes
using analog fax 294
cannot send or receive faxes
using etherFAX 297
cannot send the fax cover page
from the computer 298
Card Copy 83
setting up 26
changing fax resolution 86
changing the wallpaper 27
checking the status of parts and
supplies 180
cleaning
exterior of the printer 229
interior of the printer 229
cleaning the ADF pick roller 233
cleaning the ADF rollers 233
cleaning the ADF separator
roller 233
cleaning the printer 229
Cleaning the Scanner 177
cleaning the scanner 230
cleaning the touch screen 229
clearing jam
in automatic document
feeder 278
in the manual feeder 283
in the multipurpose feeder 284
in trays 282
collated printing does not
work 290
collating copies 82
color correction 306
color quality, troubleshooting
print appears tinted 308
colored background on print 251
computer
connecting to the printer 70
computer, scanning to 89
confidential
documents do not
print 270
confidential print jobs
configuring
78
printing 79
configuring daylight saving
time 39
configuring
fax speaker
settings 39
configuring supply
notifications 180
configuring
the email server
settings 39
configuring WiFi Direct 69
connecting a computer to the
printer 70
connecting mobile device
to printer 70
connecting the printer
to a wireless network 68
connecting to a wireless network
using PIN method 69
using Push Button method 69
conserving supplies 237
contacting customer
support 308
control panel
using 12
Index 330
background
convenience stapler
installing 65
red indicator light 288
copy quality problem
partial copies of documents 301
partial copies of photos 301
poor copy quality 302
vertical dark streaks 302
copying
on both sides of the paper 82
on letterhead 82
photos 81
separator sheets between
copies 82
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 81
using the scanner glass 81
copying cards 83
copying dierent paper sizes 81
copying from
selected tray 81
copying multiple pages
onto a single sheet 83
copying problem
scanner does not close 304
scanner does not respond 305
creating a shortcut
copy 83
network folder 91
creating bookmarks 28
creating folders
for bookmarks 29
creating shortcut
email 84
fax destination 86
FTP address 91
creating shortcuts 26
crooked print 258
Customer Support
using 27
customer support
contacting 308
customizing the display 27
D
dark print 248
date and time
fax settings 39
daylight saving time
configuring 39
deactivating the WiFi network 71
deactivating Voice Guidance 30
default headphone volume
adjusting 32
default speaker volume
adjusting 32
defective intelligent storage
drive 287
deleting contact groups 29
deleting contacts 29
developer unit
ordering 183
replacing 199
Device Quotas
setting up 28
dierent paper sizes, copying 81
directory list
printing 80
disabling SMTP server not set up
error 292
display brightness
adjusting 237
Display Customization
using 27
displaying apps on home
screen 25
distinctive ring
fax setup 39
documents, printing
from a computer 75
from a mobile device 75
dots on printed page 256
E
editing contacts 29
emission
notices 311, 320, 324, 326
enabling distinctive ring 39
enabling Magnification mode 31
enabling personal identification
numbers 32
enabling spoken passwords 32
enabling the USB port 275
enabling WiFi Direct 70
enlarging a copy size 82
envelope seals when
printing 289
envelopes
loading 49
environmental settings 237
erasing
printer memory 72
erasing printer memory 73
erasing printer storage drive 73
error codes 240
error messages 240
etherFAX
setting up fax function 34
Ethernet port 23
exporting a configuration file
using the Embedded Web
Server 56
email
sending 84
email alerts
setting up 180
email function
setting up 39
email server
configuring 39
email service providers 39
email shortcut
creating 84
email troubleshooting
cannot send emails 293
emailing
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 84
using the scanner glass 84
F
factory default settings
restoring 73
FAQ about color printing 307
fax
sending 85
fax darkness
adjusting 87
fax destination shortcut
creating 86
fax driver
installing 54
fax log
printing 87
fax resolution
changing 86
fax server, using
setting up the fax function 35
fax setup
standard telephone line
connection 35
using dierent plugs 37
using dierent wall jacks 37
fax speaker settings
configuring 39
Index 331
background
fax troubleshooting
caller ID is not shown 293
can send but not receive faxes
using analog fax 296
cannot send faxes using analog
fax 296
cannot send or receive faxes
using analog fax 294
cannot send or receive faxes
using etherFAX 297
cannot send the fax cover page
from the computer 298
cannot set up etherFAX 296
missing information on the fax
cover page 298
poor print quality 298
fax, scheduling 86
faxing
setting the date and time 39
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 85
using the scanner glass 85
FCC notices 320
finding printer information 9
firmware card 56
firmware, updating 55
flash drive
printing from 77
scanning to 92
font sample list
printing 80
forwarding fax 87
FTP address
creating shortcut 91
FTP server, scanning to
using the control panel 90
fuser maintenance kit
ordering 183
G
genuine Lexmark parts and
supplies 181
genuine parts and supplies 181
ghost images on prints 250
gray background on print 251
H
hard disk 56
erasing 73
hard disk storage drive 73
hardware options
trays 57
hardware options, adding
print driver 56
held documents do not print 270
held jobs
printing 79
setting expiration time 78
Hibernate mode
configuring 237
holding faxes 87
home screen
customizing 25
using 24
home screen icons
displaying 25
horizontal dark lines 263
horizontal white lines 265
humidity around the printer 314
I
icons on the home screen
showing 25
images cut o on print 260
imaging kit
ordering 183
replacing 186
importing a configuration file
using the Embedded Web
Server 56
incorrect margins 252
indicator light
understanding the status 12
installing convenience stapler 65
installing internal options
intelligent storage drive 58
installing options
printer hard disk 60
installing the fax driver 54
installing the print driver 54
installing the printer software 54
installing trays 57
intelligent storage drive 56, 73
erasing 73
installing 58
internal options 56
internal options, adding
print driver 56
J
jagged image
scanning from ADF 303
jagged text
scanning from ADF 303
jam areas
locating 276
jam, clearing
in the manual feeder 283
in the multipurpose feeder 284
jammed pages are not
reprinted 292
jams, clearing
in the duplex unit 279
in the fuser 279
jams, paper
avoiding 275
job prints from the wrong
tray 271
job prints on the wrong
paper 271
junk faxes
blocking 87
L
letterhead
copying on 82
loading 49
selecting 14
Lexmark Mobile Print
using 75
Lexmark Print
using 75
Lexmark ScanBack Utility 89
light print 253
line port 23
linking trays 53
loading card stock 51
loading envelopes 51
loading multipurpose feeder 51
loading the manual feeder 49
loading trays 47
locating jam areas 276
locating the security slot 72
M
Magnification mode
enabling 31
making copies 81
managing screen saver 27
manual color correction 306
Index 332
background
manual feeder
loading 49
MarkNet N8450 Wireless Print
Server 212
menu
802.1x 164
About this Printer 109
Accessibility 101
AirPrint 158
Anonymous Data Collection 101
Cloud Services Enrollment 175
Confidential Print Setup 173
Configuration Menu 103
Copy Defaults 120
Custom Scan Sizes 119
Default Login Methods 169
Device 176
Disk Encryption 174
EcoMode 96
Erase Temporary Data Files 174
Ethernet 159
Email Defaults 140
Email Setup 139
Fax 177
Fax Mode 124
Fax Server Setup 135
Fax Setup 124
Flash Drive Print 152
Flash Drive Scan 149
Forms Merge 177
FTP Defaults 145
Home Screen
Customization 108
HTTP/FTP Settings 166
Image 117
IPSec 163
Job Accounting 113
Layout 109
Local Accounts 169
Login Restrictions 173
LPD Configuration 165
Manage Permissions 168
Media Types 120
Menu Settings Page 176
Miscellaneous 175
Mobile Services
Management 159
Network 177
Network Overview 154
Notifications 97
Out of Service Erase 108
PCL 115
PDF 114
PostScript 115
Power Management 100
Preferences 94
Print 176
Quality 112
Remote Operator Panel 97
Restore Factory Defaults 102
Restrict external network
access 167
Schedule USB Devices 170
Security Audit Log 170
Setup 110
Shortcuts 177
SNMP 162
Solutions LDAP Settings 174
TCP/IP 160
ThinPrint 166
Tray Configuration 118
Troubleshooting 177
Universal Setup 118
Update Firmware 108
USB 167
Web Link Setup 145
Wireless 155
WiFi Direct 157
Menu Settings Page
printing 179
missing colors 255
missing information on the fax
cover page 298
mobile device
connecting to printer 70
printing from 75, 76
modifying color output 306
Mopria Print Service 76
mottled print and dots 256
moving the printer 22, 237
multipurpose feeder
loading 51
N
navigating the screen
using gestures 30
navigating the screen using
gestures 30
network folder
creating a shortcut 91
network setup page
printing 71
noise emission levels 311
nonvolatile memory
erasing 72
NonLexmark supply 289
nonvolatile memory 73
Not enough free space in flash
memory for resources 288
notices 311, 313, 315, 316, 320,
322, 324, 325, 326
O
onscreen keyboard
using 31
ordering supplies
developer unit 183
fuser maintenance kit 183
imaging kit 183
toner cartridge 181
waste toner bottle 183
P
paper
letterhead 14
preprinted forms 14
selecting 12
unacceptable 14
Universal size setting 47
paper characteristics 13
paper frequently jams 291
paper guidelines 12
paper jam
in the manual feeder 283
in the multipurpose feeder 284
in trays 282
paper jam in automatic document
feeder 278
paper jam in door A 279
paper jams
avoiding 275
paper jams, clearing
in the duplex unit 279
in the fuser 279
paper sizes
supported 15
paper types
supported 20
paper weights
supported 21
partial copies of documents 301
partial copies of photos 301
parts status
checking 180
Index 333
background
personal identification number
method 69
personal identification numbers
enabling 32
photos, copying 81
pick tires
replacing 207
placing separator sheets 80
between copies 82
poor copy quality 302
poor fax print quality 298
power cord socket 23
power save modes
configuring 237
power supply
replacing 224
preprinted forms
selecting 14
print appears tinted 308
print driver
hardware options, adding 56
installing 54
print job
canceling 80
print jobs not print 269
print quality problem
crooked print 258
repeating print defects 268
skewed print 258
Print Quality Test Pages 177
print quality troubleshooting
blank pages 247
dark print 248
ghost images appear on
prints 250
gray or colored
background 251
horizontal dark lines 263
horizontal white lines 265
light print 253
missing colors 255
mottled print and dots 256
paper curl 257
solid color or black images 259
text or images cut o 260
toner easily rubs o 261
uneven print density 262
vertical dark lines appear on
prints 264
vertical white lines 266
white pages 247
print troubleshooting
collated printing does not
work 290
confidential and other held
documents do not print 270
envelope seals when
printing 289
incorrect margins 252
job prints from the wrong
tray 271
job prints on the wrong
paper 271
paper frequently jams 291
slow printing 271
tray linking does not work 290
unable to read flash drive 274
printer
minimum clearances 22
selecting a location for 22
shipping 238
printer configurations 10
printer error codes 240
printer error messages 240
printer hard disk
installing 60
printer is not responding 273
printer memory
erasing 72
printer menus 93, 179
printer messages
Defective flash detected 287
NonLexmark supply 289
Not enough free space in flash
memory for resources 288
Replace cartridge, printer region
mismatch 288
printer options troubleshooting
cannot detect internal
option 287
printer ports 23
printer serial number 10
printer settings
restoring factory default 73
printer software
installing 54
printer status 12
printers supporting wireless
connection 68
printing
confidential print jobs 79
directory list 80
fax log 87
font sample list 80
from a computer 75
from a flash drive 77
from a mobile device 76
held jobs 79
Menu Settings Page 179
network setup page 71
using Mopria Print Service 76
using WiFi Direct 76
printing a directory list 80
printing a font sample list 80
printing a network setup page 71
printing from a computer 75
printing problem
print jobs do not print 269
Push Button method 69
R
received faxes
holding 87
recycling
Lexmark packaging 309
recycling Lexmark products 309
red indicator light
on the convenience
stapler 288
reducing a copy size 82
removing paper jam
in automatic document
feeder 278
in trays 282
repeat print jobs 78
repeating print defects 268
Replace cartridge, printer region
mismatch 288
replacing parts
ADF pick roller 215
ADF rollers 215
ADF separator roller 215
pick tires 207
right cover 210
scanner glass pad 220
replacing power supply 224
replacing staple
refill
222
replacing supplies
black and color imaging kit 186
black imaging kit 186
developer unit 199
toner cartridge 184
waste toner bottle 195
replacing wireless print
server 212
Index 334
background
reports
printer status 181
printer usage 181
resetting
supply usage counters 289
resetting supply usage
counters 229
resetting the supply usage
counters 289
restoring factory default
settings 73
right cover
replacing 210
RJ11 adapter 37
running a slideshow 27
S
safety information 7, 8
saving paper 83
Scan Center
setting up 26
scan job not successful 303
scan quality problem
jagged image 303
jagged text 303
partial copies of documents 301
partial copies of photos 301
poor copy quality 302
vertical dark streaks 302
scan troubleshooting
cannot scan to a computer 299
cannot scan to network
folder 300
scanner
cleaning 230
scanner does not close 304
scanner does not respond 305
scanner glass pad
replacing 220
scanning
to a computer 89
to an FTP server 90
to flash drive 92
using the automatic document
feeder (ADF) 89
using the scanner glass 89
scanning from the ADF
vertical dark streaks 302
scanning problem
scan job not successful 303
scanner does not close 304
scanner does not respond 305
scanning freezes the
computer 304
scanning takes too long 304
scanning to a network folder 91
scanning to an FTP server
using the control panel 90
scheduling a fax 86
securing printer data 73
security slot
locating 72
selecting location
for the printer 22
sending email 84
sending fax 85
separator sheets
placing 80
serial number, printer
finding 10
setting the paper size 47
setting the paper type 47
setting the Universal paper
size 47
setting up analog fax 33
setting up Device Quotas 28
setting up email alerts 180
setting up fax
standard telephone line
connection 35
using dierent plugs 37
using dierent wall jacks 37
setting up fax function
using etherFAX 34
setting up the fax function using
fax server 35
shipping the printer 238
shortcut
Copy 26
Email 26
Fax 26
FTP 26
shortcut, creating
email 84
fax destination 86
FTP address 91
shortcut, creating a
copy 83
shortcuts
creating 26
skewed print 258
Sleep mode
configuring 237
slow printing 271
SMB
scanning 91
SMTP server not set up error
disabling 292
SMTP settings
configuring 39
solid color 259
sorting multiple copies 82
spoken passwords
enabling 32
staple refill
replacing 222
statement of volatility 73
storage drive
erasing 73
storing paper 14
storing print jobs 78
supplies
conserving 237
supplies status
checking 180
supply notifications
configuring 180
supply usage counters
resetting 229, 289
supported applications 25
supported fax 33
supported file types 78
supported flash drives 78
supported paper sizes 15
supported paper types 20
supported paper weights 21
T
temperature around the
printer 314
text cut o on print 260
toner cartridge
ordering 181
replacing 184
toner darkness
adjusting 80
toner easily rubs o 261
touch screen
cleaning 229
trays
installing 57
linking 53
loading 47
unlinking 53
Index 335
background
troubleshooting
cannot connect printer to
WiFi 286
cannot open Embedded Web
Server 284
FAQ about color printing 307
printer is not responding 273
SMTP server not set up
error 292
troubleshooting, color quality
print appears tinted 308
troubleshooting, email
cannot send emails 293
troubleshooting, fax
caller ID is not shown 293
can send but not receive faxes
using analog fax 296
cannot send faxes using analog
fax 296
cannot send or receive faxes
using analog fax 294
cannot send or receive faxes
using etherFAX 297
cannot send the fax cover page
from the computer 298
cannot set up etherFAX 296
missing information on the fax
cover page 298
poor print quality 298
troubleshooting, print
collated printing does not
work 290
confidential and other held
documents do not print 270
envelope seals when
printing 289
incorrect margins 252
jammed pages are not
reprinted 292
job prints from the wrong
tray 271
job prints on the wrong
paper 271
paper frequently jams 291
slow printing 271
tray linking does not work 290
troubleshooting, print quality
blank pages 247
dark print 248
ghost images appear on
prints 250
gray or colored
background 251
horizontal dark lines 263
horizontal white lines 265
light print 253
missing colors 255
mottled print and dots 256
paper curl 257
solid color or black images 259
text or images cut o 260
toner easily rubs o 261
uneven print density 262
vertical dark lines appear on
prints 264
vertical white lines 266
white pages 247
troubleshooting, printer options
cannot detect internal
option 287
troubleshooting, scan
cannot scan to a computer 299
cannot scan to a network
folder 300
twosided copying 82
U
unable to read flash drive
troubleshooting, print 274
uneven print density 262
Universal paper size
setting 47
unlinking trays 53
updating firmware 55
USB port 23
enabling 275
using Customer Support 27
using Display Customization 27
using genuine Lexmark parts and
supplies 181
using the ADF
copying 81
using the control panel 12
using the home screen 24
using the scanner glass
copying 81
V
verify print jobs 78
vertical dark lines on prints 264
vertical dark streaks
when scanning from the
ADF 302
vertical white lines 266
viewing reports 181
Voice Guidance
activating 30
deactivating 30
speech rate 32
Voice Guidance speech rate
adjusting 32
volatile memory 73
erasing 72
W
waste toner bottle
ordering 183
replacing 195
white pages 247
wireless network 68
connecting the printer to 68
WiFi Protected Setup 69
wireless networking 68
wireless print server
replacing 212
WiFi Direct
configuring 69
enabling 70
printing from a mobile
device 76
WiFi network
deactivating 71
WiFi Protected Setup
wireless network 69
Index 336

Specifications

Lexmark 50M7080 Questions and Answers